Mention mi0 and mi1 as --interpreter options.
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @set EDITION Ninth
32
33 @c !!set GDB manual's revision date
34 @set DATE April 2001
35
36 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 3.12 OR LATER.
37
38 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
39 @c manuals to an info tree.
40 @dircategory Programming & development tools.
41 @direntry
42 * Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
43 @end direntry
44
45 @ifinfo
46 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
47
48
49 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
50 of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
51 for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
52
53 Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1990,1991,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1998,1999,2000,2001
54 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
55
56 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
57 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
58 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
59 Invariant Sections being ``A Sample GDB Session'' and ``Free
60 Software'', with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' and
61 with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
62
63 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
64 this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
65 Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
66 @end ifinfo
67
68 @titlepage
69 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
70 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
71 @sp 1
72 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
73 @subtitle @value{DATE}
74 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
75 @page
76 @tex
77 {\parskip=0pt
78 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
79 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
80 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
81 }
82 @end tex
83
84 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
85 Copyright @copyright{} 1988,1989,1990,1991,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1998,1999,2000,2001
86 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
87 @sp 2
88 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
89 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
90 Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
91 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
92
93 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
94 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
95 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
96 Invariant Sections being ``A Sample GDB Session'' and ``Free
97 Software'', with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' and
98 with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
99
100 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
101 this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
102 Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
103 @end titlepage
104 @page
105
106 @ifinfo
107 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
108
109 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
110
111 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
112
113 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
114 @value{GDBVN}.
115
116 Copyright (C) 1988-2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
117
118 @menu
119 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
120 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
121
122 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
123 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
124 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
125 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
126 * Stack:: Examining the stack
127 * Source:: Examining source files
128 * Data:: Examining data
129 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
130
131 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
132
133 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
134 * Altering:: Altering execution
135 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
136 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
137 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
138 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
139 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
140 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
141 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
142 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
143
144 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
145 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
146
147 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
148 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
149 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
150 * Index:: Index
151 @end menu
152
153 @end ifinfo
154
155 @c the replication sucks, but this avoids a texinfo 3.12 lameness
156
157 @ifhtml
158 @node Top
159
160 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
161
162 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
163
164 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
165 @value{GDBVN}.
166
167 Copyright (C) 1988-2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
168
169 @menu
170 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
171 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
172
173 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
174 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
175 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
176 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
177 * Stack:: Examining the stack
178 * Source:: Examining source files
179 * Data:: Examining data
180
181 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
182
183 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
184 * Altering:: Altering execution
185 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
186 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
187 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
188 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
189 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
190 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
191 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
192
193 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
194 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
195
196 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
197 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
198 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
199 * Index:: Index
200 @end menu
201
202 @end ifhtml
203
204 @c TeX can handle the contents at the start but makeinfo 3.12 can not
205 @iftex
206 @contents
207 @end iftex
208
209 @node Summary
210 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
211
212 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
213 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
214 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
215
216 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
217 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
218
219 @itemize @bullet
220 @item
221 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
222
223 @item
224 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
225
226 @item
227 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
228
229 @item
230 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
231 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
232 @end itemize
233
234 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
235 For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
236 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
237
238 @cindex Chill
239 @cindex Modula-2
240 Support for Modula-2 and Chill is partial. For information on Modula-2,
241 see @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}. For information on Chill, see @ref{Chill}.
242
243 @cindex Pascal
244 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
245 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
246 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
247 syntax.
248
249 @cindex Fortran
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
251 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
252 underscore.
253
254 @menu
255 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Contributors
276 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
277
278 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
279 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
280 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
281 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
282 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
283 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
284 blow-by-blow account.
285
286 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
287
288 @quotation
289 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
290 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
291 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
292 @end quotation
293
294 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
295 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
296 releases:
297 Andrew Cagney (releases 5.0 and 5.1);
298 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
299 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
300 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
301 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
302 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
303 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
304 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
305 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
306
307 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
308 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
309
310 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
311 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
312 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
313 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
314 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
315
316 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
317 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
318 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
319
320 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
321 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
322
323 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF2 support.
324
325 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
326 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
327 support.
328 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
329 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
330 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
331 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
332 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
333 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
334 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
335 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
336 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
337 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
338 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
339 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
340 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
341 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
342 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
343
344 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K Linux support.
345
346 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
347 libraries.
348
349 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
350 about several machine instruction sets.
351
352 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
353 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
354 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
355 and RDI targets, respectively.
356
357 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
358 command-line editing and command history.
359
360 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
361 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
362
363 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
364 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
365 symbols.
366
367 Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
368 Super-H processors.
369
370 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
371
372 Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
373
374 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
375
376 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
377
378 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
379
380 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
381 watchpoints.
382
383 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
384
385 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
386
387 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
388 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
389
390 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
391 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
392 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
393 compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
394 John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
395 Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
396 information in this manual.
397
398 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
399 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
400
401 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
402 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
403 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
404 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
405 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
406 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
407 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
408 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
409 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
410 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
411 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
412 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
413 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
414 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
415 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
416
417
418 @node Sample Session
419 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
420
421 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
422 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
423 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
424
425 @iftex
426 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
427 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
428 @end iftex
429
430 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
431 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
432
433 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
434 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
435 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
436 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
437 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
438 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
439 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
440 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
441 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
442
443 @smallexample
444 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
445 $ @b{./m4}
446 @b{define(foo,0000)}
447
448 @b{foo}
449 0000
450 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
451
452 @b{bar}
453 0000
454 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
455
456 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
457 @b{baz}
458 @b{C-d}
459 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
460 @end smallexample
461
462 @noindent
463 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
464
465 @smallexample
466 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
467 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
468 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
469 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
470 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
471 the conditions.
472 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
473 for details.
474
475 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
476 (@value{GDBP})
477 @end smallexample
478
479 @noindent
480 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
481 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
482 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
483 that examples fit in this manual.
484
485 @smallexample
486 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
487 @end smallexample
488
489 @noindent
490 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
491 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
492 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
493 @code{break} command.
494
495 @smallexample
496 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
497 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
498 @end smallexample
499
500 @noindent
501 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
502 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
503 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
504
505 @smallexample
506 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
507 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
508 @b{define(foo,0000)}
509
510 @b{foo}
511 0000
512 @end smallexample
513
514 @noindent
515 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
516 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
517 context where it stops.
518
519 @smallexample
520 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
521
522 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
523 at builtin.c:879
524 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
525 @end smallexample
526
527 @noindent
528 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
529 the next line of the current function.
530
531 @smallexample
532 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
533 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
534 : nil,
535 @end smallexample
536
537 @noindent
538 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
539 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
540 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
541 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
542
543 @smallexample
544 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
545 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
546 at input.c:530
547 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
548 @end smallexample
549
550 @noindent
551 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
552 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
553 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
554 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
555 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
556 stack frame for each active subroutine.
557
558 @smallexample
559 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
560 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
561 at input.c:530
562 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
563 at builtin.c:882
564 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
565 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
566 at macro.c:71
567 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
568 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
569 @end smallexample
570
571 @noindent
572 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
573 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
574 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
575
576 @smallexample
577 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
578 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
579 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
580 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
581 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
582 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
583 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
584 : xstrdup(rq);
585 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
586 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
587 @end smallexample
588
589 @noindent
590 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
591 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
592 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
593 (@code{print}) to see their values.
594
595 @smallexample
596 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
597 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
598 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
599 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
600 @end smallexample
601
602 @noindent
603 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
604 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
605 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
606
607 @smallexample
608 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
609 533 xfree(rquote);
610 534
611 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
612 : xstrdup (lq);
613 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
614 : xstrdup (rq);
615 537
616 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
617 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
618 540 @}
619 541
620 542 void
621 @end smallexample
622
623 @noindent
624 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
625 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
626
627 @smallexample
628 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
629 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
630 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
631 540 @}
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
633 $3 = 9
634 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
635 $4 = 7
636 @end smallexample
637
638 @noindent
639 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
640 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
641 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
642 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
643 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
644 assignments.
645
646 @smallexample
647 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
648 $5 = 7
649 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
650 $6 = 9
651 @end smallexample
652
653 @noindent
654 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
655 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
656 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
657 example that caused trouble initially:
658
659 @smallexample
660 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
661 Continuing.
662
663 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
664
665 baz
666 0000
667 @end smallexample
668
669 @noindent
670 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
671 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
672 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
673
674 @smallexample
675 @b{C-d}
676 Program exited normally.
677 @end smallexample
678
679 @noindent
680 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
681 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
682 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
683
684 @smallexample
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
686 @end smallexample
687
688 @node Invocation
689 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
690
691 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
692 The essentials are:
693 @itemize @bullet
694 @item
695 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
696 @item
697 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
698 @end itemize
699
700 @menu
701 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
702 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
703 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
704 @end menu
705
706 @node Invoking GDB
707 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
708
709 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
710 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
711
712 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
713 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
714
715 The command-line options described here are designed
716 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
717 options may effectively be unavailable.
718
719 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
720 specifying an executable program:
721
722 @example
723 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
724 @end example
725
726 @noindent
727 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
728 specified:
729
730 @example
731 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
732 @end example
733
734 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
735 to debug a running process:
736
737 @example
738 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
739 @end example
740
741 @noindent
742 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
743 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
744
745 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
746 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
747 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
748 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
749 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
750
751 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
752 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
753
754 @smallexample
755 @value{GDBP} -silent
756 @end smallexample
757
758 @noindent
759 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
760 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
761
762 @noindent
763 Type
764
765 @example
766 @value{GDBP} -help
767 @end example
768
769 @noindent
770 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
771 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
772
773 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
774 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
775 @samp{-x} option is used.
776
777
778 @menu
779 * File Options:: Choosing files
780 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
781 @end menu
782
783 @node File Options
784 @subsection Choosing files
785
786 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
787 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
788 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
789 @samp{-c} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the first argument
790 that does not have an associated option flag as equivalent to the
791 @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the second argument
792 that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as equivalent to
793 the @samp{-c} option followed by that argument.)
794
795 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
796 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
797 argument and ignore it.
798
799 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
800 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
801 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
802 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
803 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
804
805 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
806 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
807 @c it.
808
809 @table @code
810 @item -symbols @var{file}
811 @itemx -s @var{file}
812 @cindex @code{--symbols}
813 @cindex @code{-s}
814 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
815
816 @item -exec @var{file}
817 @itemx -e @var{file}
818 @cindex @code{--exec}
819 @cindex @code{-e}
820 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
821 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
822
823 @item -se @var{file}
824 @cindex @code{--se}
825 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
826 file.
827
828 @item -core @var{file}
829 @itemx -c @var{file}
830 @cindex @code{--core}
831 @cindex @code{-c}
832 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
833
834 @item -c @var{number}
835 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command
836 (unless there is a file in core-dump format named @var{number}, in which
837 case @samp{-c} specifies that file as a core dump to read).
838
839 @item -command @var{file}
840 @itemx -x @var{file}
841 @cindex @code{--command}
842 @cindex @code{-x}
843 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
844 Files,, Command files}.
845
846 @item -directory @var{directory}
847 @itemx -d @var{directory}
848 @cindex @code{--directory}
849 @cindex @code{-d}
850 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
851
852 @item -m
853 @itemx -mapped
854 @cindex @code{--mapped}
855 @cindex @code{-m}
856 @emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
857 supported on all systems.}@*
858 If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
859 system call, you can use this option
860 to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
861 program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
862 called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
863 Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
864 and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
865 the symbol table from the executable program.
866
867 The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
868 is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
869 table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
870
871 @item -r
872 @itemx -readnow
873 @cindex @code{--readnow}
874 @cindex @code{-r}
875 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
876 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
877 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
878
879 @end table
880
881 You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
882 order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
883 information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
884 on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
885 but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
886
887 @example
888 gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
889 @end example
890
891 @node Mode Options
892 @subsection Choosing modes
893
894 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
895 batch mode or quiet mode.
896
897 @table @code
898 @item -nx
899 @itemx -n
900 @cindex @code{--nx}
901 @cindex @code{-n}
902 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files (normally
903 called @file{.gdbinit}, or @file{gdb.ini} on PCs). Normally,
904 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
905 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
906 files}.
907
908 @item -quiet
909 @itemx -silent
910 @itemx -q
911 @cindex @code{--quiet}
912 @cindex @code{--silent}
913 @cindex @code{-q}
914 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
915 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
916
917 @item -batch
918 @cindex @code{--batch}
919 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
920 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
921 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
922 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
923 in the command files.
924
925 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
926 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
927 make this more useful, the message
928
929 @example
930 Program exited normally.
931 @end example
932
933 @noindent
934 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
935 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
936 mode.
937
938 @item -nowindows
939 @itemx -nw
940 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
941 @cindex @code{-nw}
942 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
943 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
944 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
945
946 @item -windows
947 @itemx -w
948 @cindex @code{--windows}
949 @cindex @code{-w}
950 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
951 used if possible.
952
953 @item -cd @var{directory}
954 @cindex @code{--cd}
955 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
956 instead of the current directory.
957
958 @item -fullname
959 @itemx -f
960 @cindex @code{--fullname}
961 @cindex @code{-f}
962 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
963 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
964 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
965 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
966 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
967 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
968 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
969 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
970 frame.
971
972 @item -epoch
973 @cindex @code{--epoch}
974 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
975 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
976 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
977 separate window.
978
979 @item -annotate @var{level}
980 @cindex @code{--annotate}
981 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
982 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
983 (@pxref{Annotations}).
984 Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
985 together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
986 types of output. Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
987 @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
988 maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
989
990 @item -async
991 @cindex @code{--async}
992 Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
993 @value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
994 special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
995 commands in parallel with the debugged process being
996 run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
997 MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
998 suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
999 control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
1000 (@emph{Note:} as of version 5.1, the target side of the asynchronous
1001 operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1002 yet.)
1003 @c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1004 @c should be removed.
1005
1006 When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1007 uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1008 @samp{-noasync} option.
1009
1010 @item -noasync
1011 @cindex @code{--noasync}
1012 Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1013
1014 @item -baud @var{bps}
1015 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1016 @cindex @code{--baud}
1017 @cindex @code{-b}
1018 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1019 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1020
1021 @item -tty @var{device}
1022 @itemx -t @var{device}
1023 @cindex @code{--tty}
1024 @cindex @code{-t}
1025 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1026 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1027
1028 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1029 @c @item -tui
1030 @c @cindex @code{--tui}
1031 @c Use a Terminal User Interface. For information, use your Web browser to
1032 @c read the file @file{TUI.html}, which is usually installed in the
1033 @c directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX systems. Do not use
1034 @c this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (see @pxref{Emacs, ,Using
1035 @c @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1036
1037 @c @item -xdb
1038 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1039 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1040 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1041 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1042 @c systems.
1043
1044 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1045 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1046 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1047 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1048 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1049
1050 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi1}) causes
1051 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{gdb/mi interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, , The
1052 @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}). The older @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in
1053 @value{GDBN} version 5.0 can be selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi0}.
1054
1055 @item -write
1056 @cindex @code{--write}
1057 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1058 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1059 (@pxref{Patching}).
1060
1061 @item -statistics
1062 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1063 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1064 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1065
1066 @item -version
1067 @cindex @code{--version}
1068 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1069 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1070
1071 @end table
1072
1073 @node Quitting GDB
1074 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1075 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1076 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1077
1078 @table @code
1079 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1080 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1081 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1082 @itemx q
1083 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1084 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1085 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1086 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1087 error code.
1088 @end table
1089
1090 @cindex interrupt
1091 An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1092 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1093 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1094 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1095 until a time when it is safe.
1096
1097 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1098 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1099 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
1100
1101 @node Shell Commands
1102 @section Shell commands
1103
1104 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1105 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1106 just use the @code{shell} command.
1107
1108 @table @code
1109 @kindex shell
1110 @cindex shell escape
1111 @item shell @var{command string}
1112 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1113 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1114 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1115 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1116 @end table
1117
1118 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1119 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1120 @value{GDBN}:
1121
1122 @table @code
1123 @kindex make
1124 @cindex calling make
1125 @item make @var{make-args}
1126 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1127 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1128 @end table
1129
1130 @node Commands
1131 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1132
1133 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1134 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1135 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1136 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1137 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1138
1139 @menu
1140 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1141 * Completion:: Command completion
1142 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1143 @end menu
1144
1145 @node Command Syntax
1146 @section Command syntax
1147
1148 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1149 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1150 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1151 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1152 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1153 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1154
1155 @cindex abbreviation
1156 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1157 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1158 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1159 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1160 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1161 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1162 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1163
1164 @cindex repeating commands
1165 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1166 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1167 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1168 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1169 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1170 repeat.
1171
1172 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1173 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1174 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1175
1176 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1177 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1178 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1179 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1180 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1181
1182 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1183 @cindex comment
1184 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1185 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1186 Files,,Command files}).
1187
1188 @node Completion
1189 @section Command completion
1190
1191 @cindex completion
1192 @cindex word completion
1193 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1194 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1195 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1196 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1197
1198 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1199 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1200 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1201 enter it). For example, if you type
1202
1203 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1204 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1205 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1206 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1207 @example
1208 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1209 @end example
1210
1211 @noindent
1212 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1213 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1214
1215 @example
1216 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1217 @end example
1218
1219 @noindent
1220 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1221 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1222 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1223 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1224 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1225 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1226
1227 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1228 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1229 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1230 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1231 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1232 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1233 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1234 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1235 example:
1236
1237 @example
1238 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1239 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1240 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1241 make_abs_section make_function_type
1242 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1243 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1244 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1245 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1246 @end example
1247
1248 @noindent
1249 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1250 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1251 command.
1252
1253 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1254 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1255 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1256 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1257 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1258
1259 @cindex quotes in commands
1260 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1261 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1262 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1263 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1264 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1265 @value{GDBN} commands.
1266
1267 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1268 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1269 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1270 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1271 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1272 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1273 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1274 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1275 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1276 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1277 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1278
1279 @example
1280 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1281 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1282 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1283 @end example
1284
1285 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1286 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1287 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1288 place:
1289
1290 @example
1291 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1292 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1293 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1294 @end example
1295
1296 @noindent
1297 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1298 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1299 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1300
1301 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
1302 expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1303 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1304 see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
1305
1306
1307 @node Help
1308 @section Getting help
1309 @cindex online documentation
1310 @kindex help
1311
1312 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1313 using the command @code{help}.
1314
1315 @table @code
1316 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1317 @item help
1318 @itemx h
1319 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1320 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1321
1322 @smallexample
1323 (@value{GDBP}) help
1324 List of classes of commands:
1325
1326 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1327 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1328 data -- Examining data
1329 files -- Specifying and examining files
1330 internals -- Maintenance commands
1331 obscure -- Obscure features
1332 running -- Running the program
1333 stack -- Examining the stack
1334 status -- Status inquiries
1335 support -- Support facilities
1336 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1337 stopping the program
1338 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1339
1340 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1341 commands in that class.
1342 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1343 documentation.
1344 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1345 (@value{GDBP})
1346 @end smallexample
1347 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1348
1349 @item help @var{class}
1350 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1351 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1352 help display for the class @code{status}:
1353
1354 @smallexample
1355 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1356 Status inquiries.
1357
1358 List of commands:
1359
1360 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1361 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1362 info -- Generic command for showing things
1363 about the program being debugged
1364 show -- Generic command for showing things
1365 about the debugger
1366
1367 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1368 documentation.
1369 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1370 (@value{GDBP})
1371 @end smallexample
1372
1373 @item help @var{command}
1374 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1375 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1376
1377 @kindex apropos
1378 @item apropos @var{args}
1379 The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1380 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1381 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1382
1383 @smallexample
1384 apropos reload
1385 @end smallexample
1386
1387 @noindent
1388 results in:
1389
1390 @smallexample
1391 @c @group
1392 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1393 multiple times in one run
1394 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1395 multiple times in one run
1396 @c @end group
1397 @end smallexample
1398
1399 @kindex complete
1400 @item complete @var{args}
1401 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1402 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1403 command you want completed. For example:
1404
1405 @smallexample
1406 complete i
1407 @end smallexample
1408
1409 @noindent results in:
1410
1411 @smallexample
1412 @group
1413 if
1414 ignore
1415 info
1416 inspect
1417 @end group
1418 @end smallexample
1419
1420 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1421 @end table
1422
1423 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1424 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1425 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1426 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1427 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1428 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1429
1430 @c @group
1431 @table @code
1432 @kindex info
1433 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1434 @item info
1435 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1436 program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1437 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1438 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1439 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1440 @w{@code{help info}}.
1441
1442 @kindex set
1443 @item set
1444 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1445 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1446 @code{set prompt $}.
1447
1448 @kindex show
1449 @item show
1450 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1451 @value{GDBN} itself.
1452 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1453 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1454 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1455 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1456
1457 @kindex info set
1458 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1459 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1460 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1461 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1462 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1463 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1464 @end table
1465 @c @end group
1466
1467 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1468 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1469
1470 @table @code
1471 @kindex show version
1472 @cindex version number
1473 @item show version
1474 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1475 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1476 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1477 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1478 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1479 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1480 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1481 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1482 @value{GDBN}.
1483
1484 @kindex show copying
1485 @item show copying
1486 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1487
1488 @kindex show warranty
1489 @item show warranty
1490 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1491 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1492
1493 @end table
1494
1495 @node Running
1496 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1497
1498 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1499 debugging information when you compile it.
1500
1501 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1502 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1503 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1504 kill a child process.
1505
1506 @menu
1507 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1508 * Starting:: Starting your program
1509 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1510 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1511
1512 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1513 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1514 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1515 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1516
1517 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1518 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1519 @end menu
1520
1521 @node Compilation
1522 @section Compiling for debugging
1523
1524 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1525 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1526 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1527 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1528 and addresses in the executable code.
1529
1530 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1531 the compiler.
1532
1533 Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1534 options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1535 executables containing debugging information.
1536
1537 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1538 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1539 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1540 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1541 in pushing your luck.
1542
1543 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1544 @cindex debugging optimized code
1545 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1546 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1547 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1548 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1549 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1550 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1551
1552 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1553 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1554 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1555 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1556
1557 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1558 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1559 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1560
1561 @need 2000
1562 @node Starting
1563 @section Starting your program
1564 @cindex starting
1565 @cindex running
1566
1567 @table @code
1568 @kindex run
1569 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1570 @item run
1571 @itemx r
1572 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1573 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1574 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1575 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1576 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
1577
1578 @end table
1579
1580 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1581 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1582 that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1583 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1584
1585 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1586 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1587 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1588 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1589 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1590 divided into four categories:
1591
1592 @table @asis
1593 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1594 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1595 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1596 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1597 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1598 the arguments.
1599 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1600 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1601 @xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1602
1603 @item The @emph{environment.}
1604 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1605 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1606 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1607 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1608
1609 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1610 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1611 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1612 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1613
1614 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1615 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1616 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1617 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1618 set a different device for your program.
1619 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1620
1621 @cindex pipes
1622 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1623 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1624 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1625 wrong program.
1626 @end table
1627
1628 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1629 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1630 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1631 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1632 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1633
1634 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1635 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1636 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1637 your current breakpoints.
1638
1639 @node Arguments
1640 @section Your program's arguments
1641
1642 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1643 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1644 @code{run} command.
1645 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1646 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1647 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1648 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1649 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1650
1651 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1652 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1653 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1654 the program, not by the shell.
1655
1656 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1657 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1658
1659 @table @code
1660 @kindex set args
1661 @item set args
1662 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1663 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1664 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1665 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1666 it again without arguments.
1667
1668 @kindex show args
1669 @item show args
1670 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1671 @end table
1672
1673 @node Environment
1674 @section Your program's environment
1675
1676 @cindex environment (of your program)
1677 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1678 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1679 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1680 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1681 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1682 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1683 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1684
1685 @table @code
1686 @kindex path
1687 @item path @var{directory}
1688 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1689 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1690 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
1691 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1692 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1693 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1694 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1695
1696 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1697 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1698 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1699 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1700 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1701 @var{directory} to the search path.
1702 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1703 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1704
1705 @kindex show paths
1706 @item show paths
1707 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1708 environment variable).
1709
1710 @kindex show environment
1711 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1712 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1713 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1714 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1715 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1716
1717 @kindex set environment
1718 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
1719 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1720 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1721 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1722 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1723 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1724 null value.
1725 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1726 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1727
1728 For example, this command:
1729
1730 @example
1731 set env USER = foo
1732 @end example
1733
1734 @noindent
1735 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
1736 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1737 are not actually required.)
1738
1739 @kindex unset environment
1740 @item unset environment @var{varname}
1741 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1742 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1743 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1744 rather than assigning it an empty value.
1745 @end table
1746
1747 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1748 the shell indicated
1749 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1750 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1751 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1752 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1753 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1754 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1755 @file{.profile}.
1756
1757 @node Working Directory
1758 @section Your program's working directory
1759
1760 @cindex working directory (of your program)
1761 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1762 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1763 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1764 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1765 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1766
1767 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1768 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1769 specify files}.
1770
1771 @table @code
1772 @kindex cd
1773 @item cd @var{directory}
1774 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1775
1776 @kindex pwd
1777 @item pwd
1778 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1779 @end table
1780
1781 @node Input/Output
1782 @section Your program's input and output
1783
1784 @cindex redirection
1785 @cindex i/o
1786 @cindex terminal
1787 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
1788 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
1789 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1790 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1791 running your program.
1792
1793 @table @code
1794 @kindex info terminal
1795 @item info terminal
1796 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1797 program is using.
1798 @end table
1799
1800 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1801 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1802
1803 @example
1804 run > outfile
1805 @end example
1806
1807 @noindent
1808 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1809
1810 @kindex tty
1811 @cindex controlling terminal
1812 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1813 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1814 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1815 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1816 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1817
1818 @example
1819 tty /dev/ttyb
1820 @end example
1821
1822 @noindent
1823 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1824 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1825 that as their controlling terminal.
1826
1827 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1828 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1829 terminal.
1830
1831 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1832 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1833 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1834
1835 @node Attach
1836 @section Debugging an already-running process
1837 @kindex attach
1838 @cindex attach
1839
1840 @table @code
1841 @item attach @var{process-id}
1842 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1843 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1844 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1845 find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1846 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1847
1848 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1849 executing the command.
1850 @end table
1851
1852 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1853 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1854 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1855 also have permission to send the process a signal.
1856
1857 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1858 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1859 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1860 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1861 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1862 Specify Files}.
1863
1864 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1865 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
1866 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1867 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1868 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1869 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
1870 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1871
1872 @table @code
1873 @kindex detach
1874 @item detach
1875 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1876 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1877 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1878 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1879 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1880 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1881 executing the command.
1882 @end table
1883
1884 If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1885 attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1886 for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1887 control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1888 confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1889 messages}).
1890
1891 @node Kill Process
1892 @section Killing the child process
1893
1894 @table @code
1895 @kindex kill
1896 @item kill
1897 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1898 @end table
1899
1900 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1901 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1902 is running.
1903
1904 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
1905 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
1906 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
1907 outside the debugger.
1908
1909 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
1910 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
1911 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
1912 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
1913 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
1914 breakpoint settings).
1915
1916 @node Threads
1917 @section Debugging programs with multiple threads
1918
1919 @cindex threads of execution
1920 @cindex multiple threads
1921 @cindex switching threads
1922 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
1923 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
1924 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
1925 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
1926 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
1927 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
1928 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
1929
1930 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
1931 programs:
1932
1933 @itemize @bullet
1934 @item automatic notification of new threads
1935 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
1936 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
1937 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
1938 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
1939 @item thread-specific breakpoints
1940 @end itemize
1941
1942 @quotation
1943 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
1944 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
1945 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
1946 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
1947 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
1948 like this:
1949
1950 @smallexample
1951 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
1952 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
1953 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
1954 see the IDs of currently known threads.
1955 @end smallexample
1956 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
1957 @c doesn't support threads"?
1958 @end quotation
1959
1960 @cindex focus of debugging
1961 @cindex current thread
1962 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
1963 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
1964 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
1965 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
1966 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
1967
1968 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
1969 @cindex thread identifier (system)
1970 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
1971 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
1972 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
1973 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
1974 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
1975 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
1976 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
1977 LynxOS, you might see
1978
1979 @example
1980 [New process 35 thread 27]
1981 @end example
1982
1983 @noindent
1984 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
1985 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
1986 further qualifier.
1987
1988 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
1989 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
1990 @c second---i.e., when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
1991 @c program?
1992 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
1993 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
1994 @c threads ab initio?
1995
1996 @cindex thread number
1997 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
1998 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
1999 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2000
2001 @table @code
2002 @kindex info threads
2003 @item info threads
2004 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2005 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2006
2007 @enumerate
2008 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2009
2010 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2011
2012 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2013 @end enumerate
2014
2015 @noindent
2016 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2017 indicates the current thread.
2018
2019 For example,
2020 @end table
2021 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2022
2023 @smallexample
2024 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2025 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2026 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2027 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2028 at threadtest.c:68
2029 @end smallexample
2030
2031 On HP-UX systems:
2032
2033 @cindex thread number
2034 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2035 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2036 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2037 thread in your program.
2038
2039 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2040 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2041 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2042 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2043 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2044 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2045 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2046 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2047 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2048 HP-UX, you see
2049
2050 @example
2051 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2052 @end example
2053
2054 @noindent
2055 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2056
2057 @table @code
2058 @kindex info threads
2059 @item info threads
2060 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2061 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2062
2063 @enumerate
2064 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2065
2066 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2067
2068 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2069 @end enumerate
2070
2071 @noindent
2072 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2073 indicates the current thread.
2074
2075 For example,
2076 @end table
2077 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2078
2079 @example
2080 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2081 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2082 at quicksort.c:137
2083 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2084 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2085 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2086 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2087 @end example
2088
2089 @table @code
2090 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2091 @item thread @var{threadno}
2092 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2093 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2094 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2095 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2096 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2097
2098 @smallexample
2099 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2100 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2101 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2102 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2103 @end smallexample
2104
2105 @noindent
2106 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2107 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2108 threads.
2109
2110 @kindex thread apply
2111 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2112 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2113 more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2114 with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2115 @value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
2116 threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2117 @code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
2118 @end table
2119
2120 @cindex automatic thread selection
2121 @cindex switching threads automatically
2122 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2123 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2124 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2125 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2126 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2127 thread.
2128
2129 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2130 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2131 programs with multiple threads.
2132
2133 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2134 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2135
2136 @node Processes
2137 @section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2138
2139 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2140 @cindex multiple processes
2141 @cindex processes, multiple
2142 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2143 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2144 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2145 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2146 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2147 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2148 will cause it to terminate.
2149
2150 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2151 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2152 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2153 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2154 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2155 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2156 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2157 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2158 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2159 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2160
2161 On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2162 debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2163 @code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
2164
2165 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2166 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2167
2168 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2169 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2170
2171 @table @code
2172 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2173 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2174 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2175 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2176 process. The @var{mode} can be:
2177
2178 @table @code
2179 @item parent
2180 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2181 unimpeded. This is the default.
2182
2183 @item child
2184 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2185 unimpeded.
2186
2187 @item ask
2188 The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2189 @end table
2190
2191 @item show follow-fork-mode
2192 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2193 @end table
2194
2195 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2196 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2197 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2198 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2199 the child process's @code{main}.
2200
2201 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2202 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2203
2204 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2205 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2206 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2207 argument.
2208
2209 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2210 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2211 Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
2212
2213 @node Stopping
2214 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2215
2216 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2217 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2218 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2219
2220 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2221 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2222 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2223 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2224 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2225 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2226 explicitly request this information at any time.
2227
2228 @table @code
2229 @kindex info program
2230 @item info program
2231 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2232 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2233 @end table
2234
2235 @menu
2236 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2237 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2238 * Signals:: Signals
2239 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2240 @end menu
2241
2242 @node Breakpoints
2243 @section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2244
2245 @cindex breakpoints
2246 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2247 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2248 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2249 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2250 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2251 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2252 program.
2253
2254 In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2255 breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2256 a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2257 is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2258 not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2259 arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2260
2261 @cindex watchpoints
2262 @cindex memory tracing
2263 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2264 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2265 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2266 when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2267 command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2268 watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2269 any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2270 and watchpoints using the same commands.
2271
2272 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2273 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2274 Automatic display}.
2275
2276 @cindex catchpoints
2277 @cindex breakpoint on events
2278 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2279 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2280 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2281 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2282 catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2283 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2284 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2285
2286 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2287 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2288 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2289 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2290 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2291 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2292 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2293 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2294 enable it again.
2295
2296 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2297 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2298 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2299 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2300 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2301 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2302 all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2303
2304 @menu
2305 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2306 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2307 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2308 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2309 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2310 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2311 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2312 * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2313 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2314 @end menu
2315
2316 @node Set Breaks
2317 @subsection Setting breakpoints
2318
2319 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2320 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2321 @c
2322 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2323
2324 @kindex break
2325 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2326 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2327 @cindex latest breakpoint
2328 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2329 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2330 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2331 Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2332 convenience variables.
2333
2334 You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2335
2336 @table @code
2337 @item break @var{function}
2338 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
2339 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2340 C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2341 @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2342
2343 @item break +@var{offset}
2344 @itemx break -@var{offset}
2345 Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
2346 at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2347 (@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
2348
2349 @item break @var{linenum}
2350 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
2351 The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2352 The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
2353 code on that line.
2354
2355 @item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2356 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2357
2358 @item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2359 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2360 @var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2361 superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2362 functions.
2363
2364 @item break *@var{address}
2365 Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2366 breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2367 information or source files.
2368
2369 @item break
2370 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2371 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2372 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2373 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2374 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2375 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2376 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2377 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2378 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2379 inside loops.
2380
2381 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2382 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2383 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2384 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2385 existed when your program stopped.
2386
2387 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2388 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2389 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2390 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2391 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2392 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2393 ,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2394
2395 @kindex tbreak
2396 @item tbreak @var{args}
2397 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2398 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2399 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2400 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2401
2402 @kindex hbreak
2403 @item hbreak @var{args}
2404 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2405 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2406 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2407 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2408 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2409 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2410 provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2411 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2412 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2413 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2414 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2415 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2416 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2417 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2418
2419 @kindex thbreak
2420 @item thbreak @var{args}
2421 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2422 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2423 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2424 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2425 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2426 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2427 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2428 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2429
2430 @kindex rbreak
2431 @cindex regular expression
2432 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2433 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2434 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2435 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2436 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2437 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2438 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2439
2440 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2441 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2442 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2443 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2444 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2445 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2446
2447 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2448 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2449 classes.
2450
2451 @kindex info breakpoints
2452 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2453 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2454 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2455 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2456 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2457 not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2458
2459 @table @emph
2460 @item Breakpoint Numbers
2461 @item Type
2462 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2463 @item Disposition
2464 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2465 @item Enabled or Disabled
2466 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2467 that are not enabled.
2468 @item Address
2469 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
2470 @item What
2471 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2472 line number.
2473 @end table
2474
2475 @noindent
2476 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2477 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2478 are listed after that.
2479
2480 @noindent
2481 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
2482 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2483 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2484 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
2485 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
2486
2487 @noindent
2488 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2489 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2490 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2491 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2492 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2493 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2494 @end table
2495
2496 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2497 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2498 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2499 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2500
2501 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2502 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
2503 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for special
2504 purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C programs).
2505 These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers, starting with
2506 @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
2507
2508 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
2509 @samp{maint info breakpoints}.
2510
2511 @table @code
2512 @kindex maint info breakpoints
2513 @item maint info breakpoints
2514 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
2515 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
2516 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
2517 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
2518 is shown:
2519
2520 @table @code
2521 @item breakpoint
2522 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
2523
2524 @item watchpoint
2525 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
2526
2527 @item longjmp
2528 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
2529 @code{longjmp} calls.
2530
2531 @item longjmp resume
2532 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
2533
2534 @item until
2535 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
2536
2537 @item finish
2538 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
2539
2540 @item shlib events
2541 Shared library events.
2542
2543 @end table
2544
2545 @end table
2546
2547
2548 @node Set Watchpoints
2549 @subsection Setting watchpoints
2550
2551 @cindex setting watchpoints
2552 @cindex software watchpoints
2553 @cindex hardware watchpoints
2554 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2555 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2556 this may happen.
2557
2558 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2559 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
2560 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2561 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2562 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2563 culprit.)
2564
2565 On some systems, such as HP-UX, Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2566 @value{GDBN} includes support for
2567 hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2568 program.
2569
2570 @table @code
2571 @kindex watch
2572 @item watch @var{expr}
2573 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2574 is written into by the program and its value changes.
2575
2576 @kindex rwatch
2577 @item rwatch @var{expr}
2578 Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
2579
2580 @kindex awatch
2581 @item awatch @var{expr}
2582 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
2583 by the program.
2584
2585 @kindex info watchpoints
2586 @item info watchpoints
2587 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2588 it is the same as @code{info break}.
2589 @end table
2590
2591 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2592 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2593 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2594 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2595 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2596 statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2597
2598 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2599
2600 @example
2601 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
2602 @end example
2603
2604 @noindent
2605 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2606
2607 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2608 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2609 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2610 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2611 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2612 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2613 will print a message like this:
2614
2615 @smallexample
2616 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2617 @end smallexample
2618
2619 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2620 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2621 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2622 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2623 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2624 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2625 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2626 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2627
2628 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2629 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2630 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2631 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2632 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2633 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2634
2635 @smallexample
2636 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2637 @end smallexample
2638
2639 @noindent
2640 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2641
2642 The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2643 or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2644 data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2645 hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2646 both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2647 watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2648 @strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2649 watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
2650 @value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2651 Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2652
2653 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2654 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
2655 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2656
2657 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2658 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2659 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2660 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2661 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2662 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2663 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2664 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2665 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2666
2667 @quotation
2668 @cindex watchpoints and threads
2669 @cindex threads and watchpoints
2670 @emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2671 usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2672 can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2673 you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2674 thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2675 can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2676 @value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2677 the expression.
2678
2679 @c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
2680 @emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2681 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2682 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2683 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2684 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2685 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2686 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2687 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2688 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
2689 @end quotation
2690
2691 @node Set Catchpoints
2692 @subsection Setting catchpoints
2693 @cindex catchpoints, setting
2694 @cindex exception handlers
2695 @cindex event handling
2696
2697 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
2698 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
2699 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2700
2701 @table @code
2702 @kindex catch
2703 @item catch @var{event}
2704 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2705 @table @code
2706 @item throw
2707 @kindex catch throw
2708 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
2709
2710 @item catch
2711 @kindex catch catch
2712 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
2713
2714 @item exec
2715 @kindex catch exec
2716 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2717
2718 @item fork
2719 @kindex catch fork
2720 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2721
2722 @item vfork
2723 @kindex catch vfork
2724 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2725
2726 @item load
2727 @itemx load @var{libname}
2728 @kindex catch load
2729 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2730 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2731
2732 @item unload
2733 @itemx unload @var{libname}
2734 @kindex catch unload
2735 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2736 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2737 @end table
2738
2739 @item tcatch @var{event}
2740 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2741 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2742
2743 @end table
2744
2745 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2746
2747 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
2748 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2749
2750 @itemize @bullet
2751 @item
2752 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2753 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2754 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2755 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2756 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2757 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2758 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2759 disabled within interactive calls.
2760
2761 @item
2762 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2763
2764 @item
2765 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2766 @end itemize
2767
2768 @cindex raise exceptions
2769 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2770 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2771 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2772 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2773 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2774 out where the exception was raised.
2775
2776 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
2777 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
2778 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2779 which has the following ANSI C interface:
2780
2781 @example
2782 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
2783 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2784 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
2785 @end example
2786
2787 @noindent
2788 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2789 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2790 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2791
2792 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2793 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2794 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2795 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2796 raised.
2797
2798
2799 @node Delete Breaks
2800 @subsection Deleting breakpoints
2801
2802 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2803 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2804 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2805 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2806 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2807 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2808
2809 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2810 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2811 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2812 their breakpoint numbers.
2813
2814 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2815 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2816 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2817
2818 @table @code
2819 @kindex clear
2820 @item clear
2821 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2822 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2823 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2824 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2825
2826 @item clear @var{function}
2827 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2828 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2829
2830 @item clear @var{linenum}
2831 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2832 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2833
2834 @cindex delete breakpoints
2835 @kindex delete
2836 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
2837 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2838 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2839 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
2840 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2841 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2842 @end table
2843
2844 @node Disabling
2845 @subsection Disabling breakpoints
2846
2847 @kindex disable breakpoints
2848 @kindex enable breakpoints
2849 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2850 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2851 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2852 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2853
2854 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2855 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2856 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2857 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2858 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2859
2860 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2861 states of enablement:
2862
2863 @itemize @bullet
2864 @item
2865 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2866 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2867 @item
2868 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2869 @item
2870 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
2871 disabled.
2872 @item
2873 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
2874 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2875 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
2876 @end itemize
2877
2878 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2879 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2880
2881 @table @code
2882 @kindex disable breakpoints
2883 @kindex disable
2884 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
2885 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2886 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2887 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2888 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2889 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2890 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2891
2892 @kindex enable breakpoints
2893 @kindex enable
2894 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2895 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2896 become effective once again in stopping your program.
2897
2898 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
2899 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2900 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2901
2902 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
2903 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2904 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2905 @end table
2906
2907 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2908 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
2909 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2910 ,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2911 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2912 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2913 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2914 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2915 stepping}.)
2916
2917 @node Conditions
2918 @subsection Break conditions
2919 @cindex conditional breakpoints
2920 @cindex breakpoint conditions
2921
2922 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
2923 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
2924 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2925 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2926 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2927 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2928 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2929 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2930
2931 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2932 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2933 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2934 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2935 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2936
2937 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2938 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2939 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
2940 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
2941 one.
2942
2943 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
2944 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
2945 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
2946 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
2947 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
2948 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
2949 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
2950 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
2951 conditions for the
2952 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
2953 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
2954
2955 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
2956 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
2957 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
2958 with the @code{condition} command.
2959
2960 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
2961 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
2962 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
2963 catchpoint.
2964
2965 @table @code
2966 @kindex condition
2967 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
2968 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
2969 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
2970 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
2971 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
2972 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
2973 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
2974 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
2975 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
2976 prints an error message:
2977
2978 @example
2979 No symbol "foo" in current context.
2980 @end example
2981
2982 @noindent
2983 @value{GDBN} does
2984 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
2985 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
2986 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
2987
2988 @item condition @var{bnum}
2989 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
2990 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
2991 @end table
2992
2993 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
2994 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
2995 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
2996 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
2997 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
2998 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
2999 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3000 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3001 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3002 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3003 your program reaches it.
3004
3005 @table @code
3006 @kindex ignore
3007 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3008 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3009 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3010 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3011 takes no action.
3012
3013 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3014 a count of zero.
3015
3016 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3017 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3018 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3019 Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3020
3021 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3022 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3023 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3024
3025 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3026 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3027 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3028 variables}.
3029 @end table
3030
3031 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3032
3033
3034 @node Break Commands
3035 @subsection Breakpoint command lists
3036
3037 @cindex breakpoint commands
3038 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3039 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3040 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3041 enable other breakpoints.
3042
3043 @table @code
3044 @kindex commands
3045 @kindex end
3046 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3047 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3048 @itemx end
3049 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3050 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3051 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3052
3053 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3054 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3055
3056 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3057 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3058 recently encountered).
3059 @end table
3060
3061 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3062 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3063
3064 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3065 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3066 that resumes execution.
3067
3068 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3069 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3070 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3071 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3072 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3073
3074 @kindex silent
3075 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3076 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3077 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3078 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3079 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3080 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3081
3082 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3083 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3084 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3085
3086 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3087 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3088
3089 @example
3090 break foo if x>0
3091 commands
3092 silent
3093 printf "x is %d\n",x
3094 cont
3095 end
3096 @end example
3097
3098 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3099 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3100 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3101 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3102 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3103 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3104 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3105
3106 @example
3107 break 403
3108 commands
3109 silent
3110 set x = y + 4
3111 cont
3112 end
3113 @end example
3114
3115 @node Breakpoint Menus
3116 @subsection Breakpoint menus
3117 @cindex overloading
3118 @cindex symbol overloading
3119
3120 Some programming languages (notably C@t{++}) permit a single function name
3121 to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3122 This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3123 @samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3124 a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3125 something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3126 particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3127 you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3128 waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3129 options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3130 sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3131 @kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3132 breakpoints.
3133
3134 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3135 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3136 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3137
3138 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3139 @smallexample
3140 @group
3141 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3142 [0] cancel
3143 [1] all
3144 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3145 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3146 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3147 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3148 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3149 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3150 > 2 4 6
3151 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3152 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3153 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3154 Multiple breakpoints were set.
3155 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3156 breakpoints.
3157 (@value{GDBP})
3158 @end group
3159 @end smallexample
3160
3161 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3162 @node Error in Breakpoints
3163 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3164 @c
3165 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3166 @c
3167 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3168 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3169 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3170 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3171
3172 @example
3173 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3174 The same program may be running in another process.
3175 @end example
3176
3177 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3178
3179 @enumerate
3180 @item
3181 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3182
3183 @item
3184 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3185 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3186 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3187 Then start your program again.
3188
3189 @item
3190 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3191 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3192 to nonsharable executables.
3193 @end enumerate
3194 @c @end ifclear
3195
3196 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3197 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3198
3199 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3200 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3201 @smallexample
3202 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3203 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3204 @end smallexample
3205
3206 @noindent
3207 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3208 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3209 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3210
3211 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3212 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3213
3214
3215 @node Continuing and Stepping
3216 @section Continuing and stepping
3217
3218 @cindex stepping
3219 @cindex continuing
3220 @cindex resuming execution
3221 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3222 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3223 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3224 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3225 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3226 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
3227 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3228 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3229
3230 @table @code
3231 @kindex continue
3232 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3233 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
3234 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3235 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3236 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3237 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3238 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3239 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3240 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3241 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3242
3243 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3244 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3245 @code{continue} is ignored.
3246
3247 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3248 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3249 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3250 @code{continue}.
3251 @end table
3252
3253 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3254 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3255 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3256 different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3257
3258 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3259 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3260 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3261 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3262 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3263 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3264
3265 @table @code
3266 @kindex step
3267 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
3268 @item step
3269 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3270 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3271 abbreviated @code{s}.
3272
3273 @quotation
3274 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3275 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3276 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3277 @c distinction here.
3278 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3279 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3280 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3281 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3282 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3283 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3284 below.
3285 @end quotation
3286
3287 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3288 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3289 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3290 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3291 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3292 called within the line.
3293
3294 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3295 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
3296 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
3297 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
3298 was any debugging information about the routine.
3299
3300 @item step @var{count}
3301 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
3302 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3303 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
3304
3305 @kindex next
3306 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
3307 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3308 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
3309 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3310 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3311 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3312 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3313 is abbreviated @code{n}.
3314
3315 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3316
3317
3318 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3319 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3320 @c
3321 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3322 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3323 @c function are executed without stopping.
3324
3325 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3326 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3327 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
3328
3329 @kindex set step-mode
3330 @item set step-mode
3331 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3332 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3333 @itemx set step-mode on
3334 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
3335 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3336 information rather than stepping over it.
3337
3338 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3339 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3340 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
3341
3342 @item set step-mode off
3343 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
3344 debug information. This is the default.
3345
3346 @kindex finish
3347 @item finish
3348 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3349 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3350
3351 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3352 ,Returning from a function}).
3353
3354 @kindex until
3355 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
3356 @item until
3357 @itemx u
3358 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3359 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3360 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3361 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3362 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3363 than the address of the jump.
3364
3365 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3366 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3367 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3368 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3369 through the next iteration.
3370
3371 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3372 stack frame.
3373
3374 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3375 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3376 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3377 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3378 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3379
3380 @example
3381 (@value{GDBP}) f
3382 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3383 206 expand_input();
3384 (@value{GDBP}) until
3385 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
3386 @end example
3387
3388 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3389 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3390 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3391 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3392 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3393 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3394 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3395
3396 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3397 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3398 argument.
3399
3400 @item until @var{location}
3401 @itemx u @var{location}
3402 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3403 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3404 the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3405 ,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints,
3406 and hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.
3407
3408 @kindex stepi
3409 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
3410 @item stepi
3411 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
3412 @itemx si
3413 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3414
3415 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3416 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3417 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3418 Display,, Automatic display}.
3419
3420 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3421
3422 @need 750
3423 @kindex nexti
3424 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
3425 @item nexti
3426 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
3427 @itemx ni
3428 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3429 proceed until the function returns.
3430
3431 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3432 @end table
3433
3434 @node Signals
3435 @section Signals
3436 @cindex signals
3437
3438 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3439 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3440 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
3441 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
3442 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3443 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3444 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3445 requested an alarm).
3446
3447 @cindex fatal signals
3448 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3449 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
3450 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
3451 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3452 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3453 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3454
3455 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3456 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3457 signal.
3458
3459 @cindex handling signals
3460 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
3461 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
3462 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
3463 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3464 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3465
3466 @table @code
3467 @kindex info signals
3468 @item info signals
3469 @itemx info handle
3470 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3471 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3472 the defined types of signals.
3473
3474 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
3475
3476 @kindex handle
3477 @item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
3478 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
3479 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
3480 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
3481 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
3482 known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
3483 @end table
3484
3485 @c @group
3486 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3487 Their full names are:
3488
3489 @table @code
3490 @item nostop
3491 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3492 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3493
3494 @item stop
3495 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3496 the @code{print} keyword as well.
3497
3498 @item print
3499 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3500
3501 @item noprint
3502 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3503 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3504
3505 @item pass
3506 @itemx noignore
3507 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3508 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
3509 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
3510
3511 @item nopass
3512 @itemx ignore
3513 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
3514 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
3515 @end table
3516 @c @end group
3517
3518 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3519 program until you
3520 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3521 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3522 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3523 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3524 program sees that signal when you continue.
3525
3526 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
3527 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
3528 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
3529 erroneous signals.
3530
3531 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3532 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3533 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3534 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3535 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3536 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3537 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3538 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
3539 program a signal}.
3540
3541 @node Thread Stops
3542 @section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3543
3544 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3545 programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3546 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3547
3548 @table @code
3549 @cindex breakpoints and threads
3550 @cindex thread breakpoints
3551 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3552 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3553 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3554 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3555 writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3556
3557 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3558 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3559 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3560 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3561 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3562
3563 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3564 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3565 program.
3566
3567 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3568 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3569 breakpoint condition, like this:
3570
3571 @smallexample
3572 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
3573 @end smallexample
3574
3575 @end table
3576
3577 @cindex stopped threads
3578 @cindex threads, stopped
3579 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3580 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3581 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3582 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3583 underfoot.
3584
3585 @cindex continuing threads
3586 @cindex threads, continuing
3587 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3588 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
3589 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
3590
3591 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3592 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3593 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3594 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3595 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3596 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3597 stops.
3598
3599 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3600 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3601 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3602 first thread completes whatever you requested.
3603
3604 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3605 thread to run.
3606
3607 @table @code
3608 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3609 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3610 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3611 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3612 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3613 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3614 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
3615 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
3616 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
3617 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
3618 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
3619 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
3620
3621 @item show scheduler-locking
3622 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3623 @end table
3624
3625
3626 @node Stack
3627 @chapter Examining the Stack
3628
3629 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3630 stopped and how it got there.
3631
3632 @cindex call stack
3633 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3634 is generated.
3635 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3636 the arguments of the call,
3637 and the local variables of the function being called.
3638 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
3639 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3640 stack}.
3641
3642 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3643 stack allow you to see all of this information.
3644
3645 @cindex selected frame
3646 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3647 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3648 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3649 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3650 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3651 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3652
3653 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
3654 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
3655 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3656
3657 @menu
3658 * Frames:: Stack frames
3659 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
3660 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
3661 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
3662
3663 @end menu
3664
3665 @node Frames
3666 @section Stack frames
3667
3668 @cindex frame, definition
3669 @cindex stack frame
3670 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3671 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3672 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3673 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3674 which the function is executing.
3675
3676 @cindex initial frame
3677 @cindex outermost frame
3678 @cindex innermost frame
3679 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3680 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3681 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3682 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3683 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3684 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3685 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3686 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3687
3688 @cindex frame pointer
3689 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3690 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3691 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3692 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3693 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3694 going on in that frame.
3695
3696 @cindex frame number
3697 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3698 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3699 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3700 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3701 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3702
3703 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3704 @c underflow problems.
3705 @cindex frameless execution
3706 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
3707 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
3708 @example
3709 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
3710 @end example
3711 generates functions without a frame.)
3712 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3713 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3714 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3715 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3716 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3717 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3718 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3719
3720 @table @code
3721 @kindex frame@r{, command}
3722 @cindex current stack frame
3723 @item frame @var{args}
3724 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
3725 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
3726 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3727 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
3728
3729 @kindex select-frame
3730 @cindex selecting frame silently
3731 @item select-frame
3732 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3733 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3734 @code{frame}.
3735 @end table
3736
3737 @node Backtrace
3738 @section Backtraces
3739
3740 @cindex backtraces
3741 @cindex tracebacks
3742 @cindex stack traces
3743 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3744 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3745 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3746 stack.
3747
3748 @table @code
3749 @kindex backtrace
3750 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
3751 @item backtrace
3752 @itemx bt
3753 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3754 frames in the stack.
3755
3756 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3757 character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3758
3759 @item backtrace @var{n}
3760 @itemx bt @var{n}
3761 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3762
3763 @item backtrace -@var{n}
3764 @itemx bt -@var{n}
3765 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3766 @end table
3767
3768 @kindex where
3769 @kindex info stack
3770 @kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
3771 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3772 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3773
3774 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3775 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3776 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3777 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3778 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3779 line number.
3780
3781 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3782 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3783
3784 @smallexample
3785 @group
3786 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
3787 at builtin.c:993
3788 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3789 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3790 at macro.c:71
3791 (More stack frames follow...)
3792 @end group
3793 @end smallexample
3794
3795 @noindent
3796 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3797 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3798 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3799
3800 @node Selection
3801 @section Selecting a frame
3802
3803 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3804 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3805 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3806 of the stack frame just selected.
3807
3808 @table @code
3809 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
3810 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
3811 @item frame @var{n}
3812 @itemx f @var{n}
3813 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3814 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3815 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3816 @code{main}.
3817
3818 @item frame @var{addr}
3819 @itemx f @var{addr}
3820 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3821 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3822 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3823 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3824 switches between them.
3825
3826 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3827 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3828
3829 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3830 pointer and a program counter.
3831
3832 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3833 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3834 @c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3835 @c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3836 @c as of 27 Jan 1994.
3837
3838 @kindex up
3839 @item up @var{n}
3840 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3841 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3842 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3843
3844 @kindex down
3845 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
3846 @item down @var{n}
3847 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3848 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3849 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3850 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3851 @end table
3852
3853 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3854 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3855 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
3856 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
3857
3858 @need 1000
3859 For example:
3860
3861 @smallexample
3862 @group
3863 (@value{GDBP}) up
3864 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3865 at env.c:10
3866 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3867 @end group
3868 @end smallexample
3869
3870 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3871 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
3872 @xref{List, ,Printing source lines}.
3873
3874 @table @code
3875 @kindex down-silently
3876 @kindex up-silently
3877 @item up-silently @var{n}
3878 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
3879 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3880 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3881 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3882 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3883 distracting.
3884 @end table
3885
3886 @node Frame Info
3887 @section Information about a frame
3888
3889 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
3890 stack frame.
3891
3892 @table @code
3893 @item frame
3894 @itemx f
3895 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
3896 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
3897 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
3898 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
3899 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3900
3901 @kindex info frame
3902 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
3903 @item info frame
3904 @itemx info f
3905 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
3906 including:
3907
3908 @itemize @bullet
3909 @item
3910 the address of the frame
3911 @item
3912 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
3913 @item
3914 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
3915 @item
3916 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
3917 @item
3918 the address of the frame's arguments
3919 @item
3920 the address of the frame's local variables
3921 @item
3922 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
3923 @item
3924 which registers were saved in the frame
3925 @end itemize
3926
3927 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
3928 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
3929 the usual conventions.
3930
3931 @item info frame @var{addr}
3932 @itemx info f @var{addr}
3933 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
3934 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
3935 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
3936 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
3937 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3938
3939 @kindex info args
3940 @item info args
3941 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
3942
3943 @item info locals
3944 @kindex info locals
3945 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
3946 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
3947 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
3948
3949 @kindex info catch
3950 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
3951 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
3952 @item info catch
3953 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
3954 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
3955 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
3956 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
3957 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
3958
3959 @end table
3960
3961
3962 @node Source
3963 @chapter Examining Source Files
3964
3965 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
3966 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
3967 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
3968 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
3969 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
3970 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
3971 source files by explicit command.
3972
3973 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
3974 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
3975 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
3976
3977 @menu
3978 * List:: Printing source lines
3979 * Search:: Searching source files
3980 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
3981 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
3982 @end menu
3983
3984 @node List
3985 @section Printing source lines
3986
3987 @kindex list
3988 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
3989 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
3990 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
3991 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
3992
3993 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
3994
3995 @table @code
3996 @item list @var{linenum}
3997 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
3998 current source file.
3999
4000 @item list @var{function}
4001 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4002 @var{function}.
4003
4004 @item list
4005 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4006 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4007 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4008 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4009 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4010
4011 @item list -
4012 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4013 @end table
4014
4015 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4016 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4017
4018 @table @code
4019 @kindex set listsize
4020 @item set listsize @var{count}
4021 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4022 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4023
4024 @kindex show listsize
4025 @item show listsize
4026 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4027 @end table
4028
4029 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4030 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4031 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4032 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4033 each repetition moves up in the source file.
4034
4035 @cindex linespec
4036 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4037 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4038 of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4039 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4040
4041 @table @code
4042 @item list @var{linespec}
4043 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4044
4045 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
4046 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4047 linespecs.
4048
4049 @item list ,@var{last}
4050 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4051
4052 @item list @var{first},
4053 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4054
4055 @item list +
4056 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4057
4058 @item list -
4059 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4060
4061 @item list
4062 As described in the preceding table.
4063 @end table
4064
4065 Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4066 kinds of linespec.
4067
4068 @table @code
4069 @item @var{number}
4070 Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4071 When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4072 the same source file as the first linespec.
4073
4074 @item +@var{offset}
4075 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4076 When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4077 two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4078 first linespec.
4079
4080 @item -@var{offset}
4081 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4082
4083 @item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4084 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4085
4086 @item @var{function}
4087 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4088 For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4089
4090 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4091 Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4092 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4093 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4094 identically named functions in different source files.
4095
4096 @item *@var{address}
4097 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4098 @var{address} may be any expression.
4099 @end table
4100
4101 @node Search
4102 @section Searching source files
4103 @cindex searching
4104 @kindex reverse-search
4105
4106 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4107 regular expression.
4108
4109 @table @code
4110 @kindex search
4111 @kindex forward-search
4112 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
4113 @itemx search @var{regexp}
4114 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4115 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
4116 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
4117 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4118 @code{fo}.
4119
4120 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4121 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4122 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4123 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4124 this command as @code{rev}.
4125 @end table
4126
4127 @node Source Path
4128 @section Specifying source directories
4129
4130 @cindex source path
4131 @cindex directories for source files
4132 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4133 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4134 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4135 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4136 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4137 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4138 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4139 the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4140 the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4141 path.
4142
4143 If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4144 object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4145 too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4146 compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4147 last resort.
4148
4149 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4150 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4151 each line is in the file.
4152
4153 @kindex directory
4154 @kindex dir
4155 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4156 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
4157 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4158
4159 @table @code
4160 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4161 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4162 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
4163 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4164 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4165 part of absolute file names) or
4166 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4167 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4168
4169 @kindex cdir
4170 @kindex cwd
4171 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4172 @vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
4173 @cindex compilation directory
4174 @cindex current directory
4175 @cindex working directory
4176 @cindex directory, current
4177 @cindex directory, compilation
4178 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4179 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4180 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4181 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4182 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4183 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4184
4185 @item directory
4186 Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4187
4188 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4189 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4190
4191 @item show directories
4192 @kindex show directories
4193 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4194 @end table
4195
4196 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4197 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4198 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4199
4200 @enumerate
4201 @item
4202 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4203
4204 @item
4205 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4206 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4207 directories in one command.
4208 @end enumerate
4209
4210 @node Machine Code
4211 @section Source and machine code
4212
4213 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4214 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4215 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
4216 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
4217 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
4218 well as hex.
4219
4220 @table @code
4221 @kindex info line
4222 @item info line @var{linespec}
4223 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4224 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4225 the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4226 source lines}).
4227 @end table
4228
4229 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4230 the object code for the first line of function
4231 @code{m4_changequote}:
4232
4233 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4234 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
4235 @smallexample
4236 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
4237 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4238 @end smallexample
4239
4240 @noindent
4241 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4242 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4243 @smallexample
4244 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4245 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4246 @end smallexample
4247
4248 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
4249 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
4250 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4251 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4252 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4253 ,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4254 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4255 variables}).
4256
4257 @table @code
4258 @kindex disassemble
4259 @cindex assembly instructions
4260 @cindex instructions, assembly
4261 @cindex machine instructions
4262 @cindex listing machine instructions
4263 @item disassemble
4264 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4265 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4266 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4267 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4268 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4269 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4270 @end table
4271
4272 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4273 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4274
4275 @smallexample
4276 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4277 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
4278 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
4279 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
4280 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4281 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
4282 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
4283 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
4284 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
4285 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4286 End of assembler dump.
4287 @end smallexample
4288
4289 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4290 mnemonics or other syntax.
4291
4292 @table @code
4293 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
4294 @cindex assembly instructions
4295 @cindex instructions, assembly
4296 @cindex machine instructions
4297 @cindex listing machine instructions
4298 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4299 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4300 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
4301 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4302 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4303
4304 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
4305 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4306 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4307 assemblers for x86-based targets.
4308 @end table
4309
4310
4311 @node Data
4312 @chapter Examining Data
4313
4314 @cindex printing data
4315 @cindex examining data
4316 @kindex print
4317 @kindex inspect
4318 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4319 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4320 @c different window or something like that.
4321 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
4322 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4323 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4324 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4325 Different Languages}).
4326
4327 @table @code
4328 @item print @var{expr}
4329 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4330 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4331 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
4332 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
4333 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
4334 formats}.
4335
4336 @item print
4337 @itemx print /@var{f}
4338 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
4339 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4340 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4341 @end table
4342
4343 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4344 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4345 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4346
4347 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
4348 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4349 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
4350 Table}.
4351
4352 @menu
4353 * Expressions:: Expressions
4354 * Variables:: Program variables
4355 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4356 * Output Formats:: Output formats
4357 * Memory:: Examining memory
4358 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
4359 * Print Settings:: Print settings
4360 * Value History:: Value history
4361 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4362 * Registers:: Registers
4363 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
4364 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
4365 @end menu
4366
4367 @node Expressions
4368 @section Expressions
4369
4370 @cindex expressions
4371 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4372 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4373 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
4374 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls, casts
4375 and string constants. It unfortunately does not include symbols defined
4376 by preprocessor @code{#define} commands.
4377
4378 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4379 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
4380 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
4381 memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
4382
4383 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4384 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4385 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4386 languages.
4387
4388 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4389 expressions regardless of your programming language.
4390
4391 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4392 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4393 at that address in memory.
4394 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
4395
4396 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4397 to programming languages:
4398
4399 @table @code
4400 @item @@
4401 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4402 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4403
4404 @item ::
4405 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4406 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4407
4408 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
4409 @cindex type casting memory
4410 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4411 @cindex casts, to view memory
4412 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4413 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4414 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4415 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4416 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4417 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4418 @end table
4419
4420 @node Variables
4421 @section Program variables
4422
4423 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4424 in your program.
4425
4426 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4427 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4428
4429 @itemize @bullet
4430 @item
4431 global (or file-static)
4432 @end itemize
4433
4434 @noindent or
4435
4436 @itemize @bullet
4437 @item
4438 visible according to the scope rules of the
4439 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
4440 @end itemize
4441
4442 @noindent This means that in the function
4443
4444 @example
4445 foo (a)
4446 int a;
4447 @{
4448 bar (a);
4449 @{
4450 int b = test ();
4451 bar (b);
4452 @}
4453 @}
4454 @end example
4455
4456 @noindent
4457 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4458 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4459 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4460 the block where @code{b} is declared.
4461
4462 @cindex variable name conflict
4463 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4464 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4465 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4466 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4467 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4468 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4469 using the colon-colon notation:
4470
4471 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
4472 @iftex
4473 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
4474 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
4475 @end iftex
4476 @example
4477 @var{file}::@var{variable}
4478 @var{function}::@var{variable}
4479 @end example
4480
4481 @noindent
4482 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4483 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4484 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4485 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4486
4487 @example
4488 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
4489 @end example
4490
4491 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
4492 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
4493 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
4494 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4495 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4496 @c conflict?? --mew
4497
4498 @cindex wrong values
4499 @cindex variable values, wrong
4500 @quotation
4501 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4502 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4503 scope, and just before exit.
4504 @end quotation
4505 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4506 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4507 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4508 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4509 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4510 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4511 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4512 variable definitions may be gone.
4513
4514 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4515 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4516 when compiling.
4517
4518 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4519 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4520 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4521 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4522 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4523 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4524 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4525
4526 @example
4527 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4528 @end example
4529
4530 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4531 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
4532 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler usually
4533 supports the @samp{-gstabs} option. @samp{-gstabs} produces debug info
4534 in a format that is superior to formats such as COFF. You may be able
4535 to use DWARF2 (@samp{-gdwarf-2}), which is also an effective form for
4536 debug info. See @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your
4537 Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more
4538 information.
4539
4540
4541 @node Arrays
4542 @section Artificial arrays
4543
4544 @cindex artificial array
4545 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
4546 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4547 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4548 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4549 program.
4550
4551 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4552 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4553 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4554 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4555 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4556 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4557 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4558 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4559 example. If a program says
4560
4561 @example
4562 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
4563 @end example
4564
4565 @noindent
4566 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4567
4568 @example
4569 p *array@@len
4570 @end example
4571
4572 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4573 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4574 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4575 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4576 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4577
4578 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4579 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4580 The value need not be in memory:
4581 @example
4582 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4583 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4584 @end example
4585
4586 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
4587 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
4588 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
4589 @example
4590 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4591 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4592 @end example
4593
4594 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4595 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4596 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4597 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4598 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4599 variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4600 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4601 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4602 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4603 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4604
4605 @example
4606 set $i = 0
4607 p dtab[$i++]->fv
4608 @key{RET}
4609 @key{RET}
4610 @dots{}
4611 @end example
4612
4613 @node Output Formats
4614 @section Output formats
4615
4616 @cindex formatted output
4617 @cindex output formats
4618 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4619 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4620 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4621 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4622 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4623
4624 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4625 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4626 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4627 letters supported are:
4628
4629 @table @code
4630 @item x
4631 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4632 hexadecimal.
4633
4634 @item d
4635 Print as integer in signed decimal.
4636
4637 @item u
4638 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4639
4640 @item o
4641 Print as integer in octal.
4642
4643 @item t
4644 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4645 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4646 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
4647 see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
4648
4649 @item a
4650 @cindex unknown address, locating
4651 @cindex locate address
4652 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4653 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4654 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4655
4656 @example
4657 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4658 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
4659 @end example
4660
4661 @noindent
4662 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
4663 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
4664
4665 @item c
4666 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4667
4668 @item f
4669 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4670 using typical floating point syntax.
4671 @end table
4672
4673 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4674
4675 @example
4676 p/x $pc
4677 @end example
4678
4679 @noindent
4680 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4681 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4682
4683 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4684 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4685 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4686
4687 @node Memory
4688 @section Examining memory
4689
4690 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4691 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4692
4693 @cindex examining memory
4694 @table @code
4695 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
4696 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4697 @itemx x @var{addr}
4698 @itemx x
4699 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4700 @end table
4701
4702 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4703 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4704 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4705 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4706 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4707
4708 @table @r
4709 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
4710 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4711 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4712 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4713 @c 4.1.2.
4714
4715 @item @var{f}, the display format
4716 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4717 @samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4718 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4719 The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4720
4721 @item @var{u}, the unit size
4722 The unit size is any of
4723
4724 @table @code
4725 @item b
4726 Bytes.
4727 @item h
4728 Halfwords (two bytes).
4729 @item w
4730 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4731 @item g
4732 Giant words (eight bytes).
4733 @end table
4734
4735 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4736 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4737 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4738
4739 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
4740 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4741 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4742 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4743 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4744 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4745 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4746 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4747 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4748 a value from memory).
4749 @end table
4750
4751 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4752 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4753 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4754 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
4755 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
4756
4757 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4758 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4759 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4760 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4761 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4762
4763 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4764 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4765 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4766 including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
4767 alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
4768 Code,,Source and machine code}.
4769
4770 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4771 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4772 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4773 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4774 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4775 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4776 for successive uses of @code{x}.
4777
4778 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4779 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4780 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4781 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4782 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4783 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4784 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4785 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4786 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4787
4788 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4789 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4790 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4791
4792 @node Auto Display
4793 @section Automatic display
4794 @cindex automatic display
4795 @cindex display of expressions
4796
4797 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4798 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4799 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4800 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4801 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4802 The automatic display looks like this:
4803
4804 @example
4805 2: foo = 38
4806 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
4807 @end example
4808
4809 @noindent
4810 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4811 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4812 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4813 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4814 format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4815 or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4816 supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4817
4818 @table @code
4819 @kindex display
4820 @item display @var{expr}
4821 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
4822 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4823
4824 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
4825
4826 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
4827 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
4828 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
4829 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
4830 @xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
4831
4832 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
4833 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
4834 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
4835 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
4836 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4837 @end table
4838
4839 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
4840 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
4841 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
4842
4843 @table @code
4844 @kindex delete display
4845 @kindex undisplay
4846 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
4847 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4848 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
4849
4850 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
4851 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
4852
4853 @kindex disable display
4854 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4855 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
4856 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
4857 enabled again later.
4858
4859 @kindex enable display
4860 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4861 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
4862 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
4863
4864 @item display
4865 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
4866 done when your program stops.
4867
4868 @kindex info display
4869 @item info display
4870 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
4871 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
4872 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
4873 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
4874 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
4875 @end table
4876
4877 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
4878 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
4879 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
4880 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
4881 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
4882 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
4883 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
4884 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
4885 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
4886 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
4887
4888 @node Print Settings
4889 @section Print settings
4890
4891 @cindex format options
4892 @cindex print settings
4893 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
4894 and symbols are printed.
4895
4896 @noindent
4897 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
4898
4899 @table @code
4900 @kindex set print address
4901 @item set print address
4902 @itemx set print address on
4903 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
4904 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
4905 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
4906 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
4907 @code{set print address on}:
4908
4909 @smallexample
4910 @group
4911 (@value{GDBP}) f
4912 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
4913 at input.c:530
4914 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4915 @end group
4916 @end smallexample
4917
4918 @item set print address off
4919 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
4920 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
4921
4922 @smallexample
4923 @group
4924 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
4925 (@value{GDBP}) f
4926 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
4927 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4928 @end group
4929 @end smallexample
4930
4931 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
4932 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
4933 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
4934 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
4935
4936 @kindex show print address
4937 @item show print address
4938 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
4939 @end table
4940
4941 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
4942 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
4943 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
4944 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
4945 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
4946 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
4947 it prints a symbolic address:
4948
4949 @table @code
4950 @kindex set print symbol-filename
4951 @item set print symbol-filename on
4952 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
4953 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4954
4955 @item set print symbol-filename off
4956 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
4957 default.
4958
4959 @kindex show print symbol-filename
4960 @item show print symbol-filename
4961 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
4962 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4963 @end table
4964
4965 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
4966 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
4967 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
4968
4969 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
4970 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
4971
4972 @table @code
4973 @kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
4974 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
4975 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
4976 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
4977 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
4978 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
4979
4980 @kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
4981 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
4982 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
4983 symbolic address.
4984 @end table
4985
4986 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
4987 @cindex pointer, finding referent
4988 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
4989 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
4990 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
4991 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
4992 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
4993 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
4994
4995 @example
4996 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
4997 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
4998 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
4999 @end example
5000
5001 @quotation
5002 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
5003 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
5004 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
5005 @end quotation
5006
5007 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
5008
5009 @table @code
5010 @kindex set print array
5011 @item set print array
5012 @itemx set print array on
5013 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5014 but uses more space. The default is off.
5015
5016 @item set print array off
5017 Return to compressed format for arrays.
5018
5019 @kindex show print array
5020 @item show print array
5021 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5022 arrays.
5023
5024 @kindex set print elements
5025 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5026 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5027 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5028 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5029 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
5030 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
5031 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5032
5033 @kindex show print elements
5034 @item show print elements
5035 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5036 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5037
5038 @kindex set print null-stop
5039 @item set print null-stop
5040 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
5041 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
5042 contain only short strings.
5043 The default is off.
5044
5045 @kindex set print pretty
5046 @item set print pretty on
5047 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
5048 per line, like this:
5049
5050 @smallexample
5051 @group
5052 $1 = @{
5053 next = 0x0,
5054 flags = @{
5055 sweet = 1,
5056 sour = 1
5057 @},
5058 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5059 @}
5060 @end group
5061 @end smallexample
5062
5063 @item set print pretty off
5064 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5065
5066 @smallexample
5067 @group
5068 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5069 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5070 @end group
5071 @end smallexample
5072
5073 @noindent
5074 This is the default format.
5075
5076 @kindex show print pretty
5077 @item show print pretty
5078 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5079
5080 @kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5081 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
5082 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5083 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5084 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5085 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5086 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5087
5088 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
5089 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5090 international character sets, and is the default.
5091
5092 @kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5093 @item show print sevenbit-strings
5094 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5095
5096 @kindex set print union
5097 @item set print union on
5098 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
5099 is the default setting.
5100
5101 @item set print union off
5102 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5103
5104 @kindex show print union
5105 @item show print union
5106 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5107 structures.
5108
5109 For example, given the declarations
5110
5111 @smallexample
5112 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5113 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5114 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
5115 Bug_forms;
5116
5117 struct thing @{
5118 Species it;
5119 union @{
5120 Tree_forms tree;
5121 Bug_forms bug;
5122 @} form;
5123 @};
5124
5125 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5126 @end smallexample
5127
5128 @noindent
5129 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5130
5131 @smallexample
5132 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5133 @end smallexample
5134
5135 @noindent
5136 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5137
5138 @smallexample
5139 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5140 @end smallexample
5141 @end table
5142
5143 @need 1000
5144 @noindent
5145 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
5146
5147 @table @code
5148 @cindex demangling
5149 @kindex set print demangle
5150 @item set print demangle
5151 @itemx set print demangle on
5152 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
5153 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
5154 linkage. The default is on.
5155
5156 @kindex show print demangle
5157 @item show print demangle
5158 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
5159
5160 @kindex set print asm-demangle
5161 @item set print asm-demangle
5162 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
5163 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
5164 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5165 The default is off.
5166
5167 @kindex show print asm-demangle
5168 @item show print asm-demangle
5169 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
5170 or demangled form.
5171
5172 @kindex set demangle-style
5173 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
5174 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
5175 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
5176 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
5177 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
5178
5179 @table @code
5180 @item auto
5181 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5182
5183 @item gnu
5184 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
5185 This is the default.
5186
5187 @item hp
5188 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
5189
5190 @item lucid
5191 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
5192
5193 @item arm
5194 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
5195 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5196 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5197 require further enhancement to permit that.
5198
5199 @end table
5200 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5201
5202 @kindex show demangle-style
5203 @item show demangle-style
5204 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
5205
5206 @kindex set print object
5207 @item set print object
5208 @itemx set print object on
5209 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5210 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5211 the virtual function table.
5212
5213 @item set print object off
5214 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5215 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5216
5217 @kindex show print object
5218 @item show print object
5219 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5220
5221 @kindex set print static-members
5222 @item set print static-members
5223 @itemx set print static-members on
5224 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
5225
5226 @item set print static-members off
5227 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
5228
5229 @kindex show print static-members
5230 @item show print static-members
5231 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed, or not.
5232
5233 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5234 @kindex set print vtbl
5235 @item set print vtbl
5236 @itemx set print vtbl on
5237 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
5238 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
5239 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
5240
5241 @item set print vtbl off
5242 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
5243
5244 @kindex show print vtbl
5245 @item show print vtbl
5246 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
5247 @end table
5248
5249 @node Value History
5250 @section Value history
5251
5252 @cindex value history
5253 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5254 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5255 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5256 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5257 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5258 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
5259 symbol table.
5260
5261 @cindex @code{$}
5262 @cindex @code{$$}
5263 @cindex history number
5264 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5265 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5266 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5267 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5268 history number.
5269
5270 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5271 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5272 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5273 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5274 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5275 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5276 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5277
5278 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5279 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5280
5281 @example
5282 p *$
5283 @end example
5284
5285 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5286 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5287
5288 @example
5289 p *$.next
5290 @end example
5291
5292 @noindent
5293 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5294 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5295
5296 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5297 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5298
5299 @example
5300 print x
5301 set x=5
5302 @end example
5303
5304 @noindent
5305 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5306 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5307
5308 @table @code
5309 @kindex show values
5310 @item show values
5311 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5312 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5313 values} does not change the history.
5314
5315 @item show values @var{n}
5316 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5317
5318 @item show values +
5319 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5320 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5321 @end table
5322
5323 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5324 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5325
5326 @node Convenience Vars
5327 @section Convenience variables
5328
5329 @cindex convenience variables
5330 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5331 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5332 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5333 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5334 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5335
5336 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5337 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
5338 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
5339 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5340 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5341
5342 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5343 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5344 For example:
5345
5346 @example
5347 set $foo = *object_ptr
5348 @end example
5349
5350 @noindent
5351 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5352 @code{object_ptr}.
5353
5354 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5355 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5356 value with another assignment at any time.
5357
5358 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5359 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5360 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5361 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5362
5363 @table @code
5364 @kindex show convenience
5365 @item show convenience
5366 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
5367 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
5368 @end table
5369
5370 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5371 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5372 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5373
5374 @example
5375 set $i = 0
5376 print bar[$i++]->contents
5377 @end example
5378
5379 @noindent
5380 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
5381
5382 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5383 values likely to be useful.
5384
5385 @table @code
5386 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
5387 @item $_
5388 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5389 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5390 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5391 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5392 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5393 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5394 to the type of @code{$__}.
5395
5396 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
5397 @item $__
5398 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5399 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5400 to match the format in which the data was printed.
5401
5402 @item $_exitcode
5403 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
5404 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5405 the program being debugged terminates.
5406 @end table
5407
5408 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5409 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5410 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
5411
5412 @node Registers
5413 @section Registers
5414
5415 @cindex registers
5416 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5417 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5418 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5419 your machine.
5420
5421 @table @code
5422 @kindex info registers
5423 @item info registers
5424 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5425 registers (in the selected stack frame).
5426
5427 @kindex info all-registers
5428 @cindex floating point registers
5429 @item info all-registers
5430 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5431 registers.
5432
5433 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5434 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5435 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5436 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
5437 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5438 @end table
5439
5440 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5441 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5442 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5443 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5444 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5445 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5446 register that contains the processor status. For example,
5447 you could print the program counter in hex with
5448
5449 @example
5450 p/x $pc
5451 @end example
5452
5453 @noindent
5454 or print the instruction to be executed next with
5455
5456 @example
5457 x/i $pc
5458 @end example
5459
5460 @noindent
5461 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5462 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5463 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5464 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5465 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5466 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
5467 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
5468
5469 @example
5470 set $sp += 4
5471 @end example
5472
5473 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5474 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5475 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5476 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5477 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
5478 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5479 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
5480
5481 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5482 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5483 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5484 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5485 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5486 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5487 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5488
5489 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5490 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5491 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5492 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5493 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5494 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5495 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
5496 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5497 prints the data in both formats.
5498
5499 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5500 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5501 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5502 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5503 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5504 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5505
5506 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5507 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5508 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5509 frame makes no difference.
5510
5511 @node Floating Point Hardware
5512 @section Floating point hardware
5513 @cindex floating point
5514
5515 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5516 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5517
5518 @table @code
5519 @kindex info float
5520 @item info float
5521 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5522 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5523 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5524 the ARM and x86 machines.
5525 @end table
5526
5527 @node Memory Region Attributes
5528 @section Memory Region Attributes
5529 @cindex memory region attributes
5530
5531 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
5532 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
5533 to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
5534 use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
5535
5536 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
5537 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
5538 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
5539 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
5540 all memory.
5541
5542 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
5543 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
5544
5545 @table @code
5546 @kindex mem
5547 @item mem @var{address1} @var{address1} @var{attributes}@dots{}
5548 Define memory region bounded by @var{address1} and @var{address2}
5549 with attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}.
5550
5551 @kindex delete mem
5552 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5553 Remove memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5554
5555 @kindex disable mem
5556 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5557 Disable memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5558 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
5559 It may be enabled again later.
5560
5561 @kindex enable mem
5562 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5563 Enable memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5564
5565 @kindex info mem
5566 @item info mem
5567 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
5568 for each region.
5569
5570 @table @emph
5571 @item Memory Region Number
5572 @item Enabled or Disabled.
5573 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
5574 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
5575
5576 @item Lo Address
5577 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
5578
5579 @item Hi Address
5580 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
5581
5582 @item Attributes
5583 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
5584 @end table
5585 @end table
5586
5587
5588 @subsection Attributes
5589
5590 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
5591 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
5592 write accesses to a memory region.
5593
5594 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
5595 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
5596 etc. from accessing memory.
5597
5598 @table @code
5599 @item ro
5600 Memory is read only.
5601 @item wo
5602 Memory is write only.
5603 @item rw
5604 Memory is read/write (default).
5605 @end table
5606
5607 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
5608 The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
5609 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
5610 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
5611 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
5612
5613 @table @code
5614 @item 8
5615 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
5616 @item 16
5617 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
5618 @item 32
5619 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
5620 @item 64
5621 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
5622 @end table
5623
5624 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
5625 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5626 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
5627 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
5628 @c
5629 @c @table @code
5630 @c @item hwbreak
5631 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
5632 @c @item swbreak (default)
5633 @c @end table
5634
5635 @subsubsection Data Cache
5636 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
5637 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
5638 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
5639 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
5640 registers.
5641
5642 @table @code
5643 @item cache
5644 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
5645 @item nocache (default)
5646 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory.
5647 @end table
5648
5649 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
5650 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5651 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
5652 @c
5653 @c @table @code
5654 @c @item verify
5655 @c @item noverify (default)
5656 @c @end table
5657
5658 @node Tracepoints
5659 @chapter Tracepoints
5660 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
5661 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
5662
5663 @cindex tracepoints
5664 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
5665 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
5666 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
5667 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
5668 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
5669 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
5670 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
5671
5672 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
5673 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
5674 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
5675 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
5676 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
5677 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
5678 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
5679 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
5680 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
5681 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
5682 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
5683
5684 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
5685 targets. @xref{Targets}.
5686
5687 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
5688
5689 @menu
5690 * Set Tracepoints::
5691 * Analyze Collected Data::
5692 * Tracepoint Variables::
5693 @end menu
5694
5695 @node Set Tracepoints
5696 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
5697
5698 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
5699 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
5700 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
5701 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
5702 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
5703 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
5704 work on.
5705
5706 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
5707 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
5708 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
5709 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
5710 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
5711 tracepoint was hit.
5712
5713 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
5714 conditions and actions.
5715
5716 @menu
5717 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
5718 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
5719 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
5720 * Tracepoint Actions::
5721 * Listing Tracepoints::
5722 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
5723 @end menu
5724
5725 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
5726 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
5727
5728 @table @code
5729 @cindex set tracepoint
5730 @kindex trace
5731 @item trace
5732 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
5733 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
5734 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
5735 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
5736 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
5737 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
5738 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
5739 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
5740 running.
5741
5742 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
5743
5744 @smallexample
5745 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
5746
5747 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
5748
5749 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
5750
5751 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
5752
5753 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
5754 @end smallexample
5755
5756 @noindent
5757 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
5758
5759 @vindex $tpnum
5760 @cindex last tracepoint number
5761 @cindex recent tracepoint number
5762 @cindex tracepoint number
5763 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
5764 of the most recently set tracepoint.
5765
5766 @kindex delete tracepoint
5767 @cindex tracepoint deletion
5768 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5769 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
5770 default is to delete all tracepoints.
5771
5772 Examples:
5773
5774 @smallexample
5775 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
5776
5777 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
5778 @end smallexample
5779
5780 @noindent
5781 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
5782 @end table
5783
5784 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
5785 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
5786
5787 @table @code
5788 @kindex disable tracepoint
5789 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5790 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
5791 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
5792 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
5793 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
5794
5795 @kindex enable tracepoint
5796 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5797 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
5798 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
5799 run.
5800 @end table
5801
5802 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
5803 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
5804
5805 @table @code
5806 @kindex passcount
5807 @cindex tracepoint pass count
5808 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
5809 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
5810 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
5811 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
5812 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
5813 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
5814 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
5815 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
5816 user.
5817
5818 Examples:
5819
5820 @smallexample
5821 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of tracepoint 2
5822
5823 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
5824 // most recently defined tracepoint.
5825 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
5826 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
5827 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
5828 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
5829 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
5830 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
5831 // executed 3 times OR when bar has
5832 // been executed 2 times
5833 // OR when baz has been executed 1 time.
5834 @end smallexample
5835 @end table
5836
5837 @node Tracepoint Actions
5838 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
5839
5840 @table @code
5841 @kindex actions
5842 @cindex tracepoint actions
5843 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5844 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
5845 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
5846 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
5847 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
5848 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
5849 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
5850 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
5851 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
5852 @code{while-stepping}.
5853
5854 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
5855 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
5856 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
5857
5858 @smallexample
5859 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
5860
5861 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times and collect data
5862
5863 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
5864 @end smallexample
5865
5866 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
5867 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
5868 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
5869 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
5870 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
5871 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
5872 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
5873 @code{end} command.
5874
5875 @smallexample
5876 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
5877 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
5878 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
5879 > collect bar,baz
5880 > collect $regs
5881 > while-stepping 12
5882 > collect $fp, $sp
5883 > end
5884 end
5885 @end smallexample
5886
5887 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
5888 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
5889 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
5890 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
5891 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
5892 special arguments are supported:
5893
5894 @table @code
5895 @item $regs
5896 collect all registers
5897
5898 @item $args
5899 collect all function arguments
5900
5901 @item $locals
5902 collect all local variables.
5903 @end table
5904
5905 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
5906 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
5907 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
5908
5909 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
5910 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
5911
5912 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
5913 @item while-stepping @var{n}
5914 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
5915 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
5916 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
5917 its own @code{end} command):
5918
5919 @smallexample
5920 > while-stepping 12
5921 > collect $regs, myglobal
5922 > end
5923 >
5924 @end smallexample
5925
5926 @noindent
5927 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
5928 @code{stepping}.
5929 @end table
5930
5931 @node Listing Tracepoints
5932 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
5933
5934 @table @code
5935 @kindex info tracepoints
5936 @cindex information about tracepoints
5937 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5938 Display information the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify a
5939 tracepoint number displays information about all the tracepoints
5940 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
5941 shown:
5942
5943 @itemize @bullet
5944 @item
5945 its number
5946 @item
5947 whether it is enabled or disabled
5948 @item
5949 its address
5950 @item
5951 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
5952 @item
5953 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
5954 @item
5955 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
5956 @item
5957 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
5958 @end itemize
5959
5960 @smallexample
5961 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
5962 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
5963 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
5964 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in gdb_test at gdb_test.c:375
5965 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in collect_data at ../foo.c:1741
5966 (@value{GDBP})
5967 @end smallexample
5968
5969 @noindent
5970 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
5971 @end table
5972
5973 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
5974 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
5975
5976 @table @code
5977 @kindex tstart
5978 @cindex start a new trace experiment
5979 @cindex collected data discarded
5980 @item tstart
5981 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
5982 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
5983 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
5984 experiment.
5985
5986 @kindex tstop
5987 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
5988 @item tstop
5989 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
5990 stops collecting data.
5991
5992 @strong{Note:} a trace experiment and data collection may stop
5993 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
5994 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
5995
5996 @kindex tstatus
5997 @cindex status of trace data collection
5998 @cindex trace experiment, status of
5999 @item tstatus
6000 This command displays the status of the current trace data
6001 collection.
6002 @end table
6003
6004 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
6005
6006 @smallexample
6007 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
6008 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6009 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
6010 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
6011 > while-stepping 11
6012 > collect $regs
6013 > end
6014 > end
6015 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6016 [time passes @dots{}]
6017 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
6018 @end smallexample
6019
6020
6021 @node Analyze Collected Data
6022 @section Using the collected data
6023
6024 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
6025 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
6026 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
6027 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
6028 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
6029 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
6030 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
6031 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
6032 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
6033 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
6034 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
6035 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
6036 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
6037 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
6038 the buffer will fail.
6039
6040 @menu
6041 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
6042 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
6043 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
6044 @end menu
6045
6046 @node tfind
6047 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
6048
6049 @kindex tfind
6050 @cindex select trace snapshot
6051 @cindex find trace snapshot
6052 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
6053 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
6054 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
6055 snapshot is selected.
6056
6057 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
6058
6059 @table @code
6060 @item tfind start
6061 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
6062 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
6063
6064 @item tfind none
6065 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
6066
6067 @item tfind end
6068 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
6069
6070 @item tfind
6071 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
6072
6073 @item tfind -
6074 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
6075 retracing earlier steps.
6076
6077 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
6078 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
6079 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
6080 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
6081 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
6082
6083 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
6084 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
6085 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
6086 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
6087 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
6088
6089 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6090 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
6091 addresses.
6092
6093 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6094 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
6095 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
6096
6097 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
6098 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
6099 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
6100 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
6101 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
6102 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
6103 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
6104 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
6105 @end table
6106
6107 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
6108 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
6109 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
6110 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
6111 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
6112 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
6113 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
6114 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
6115 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
6116 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
6117 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
6118 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
6119 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
6120 tracepoint as the current one.
6121
6122 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
6123 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
6124 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
6125 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
6126 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
6127
6128 @smallexample
6129 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6130 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6131 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
6132 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
6133 > tfind
6134 > end
6135
6136 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
6137 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
6138 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
6139 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
6140 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
6141 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
6142 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
6143 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
6144 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
6145 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
6146 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
6147 @end smallexample
6148
6149 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
6150 the buffer:
6151
6152 @smallexample
6153 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6154 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6155 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
6156 > tfind line
6157 > end
6158
6159 Frame 0, X = 1
6160 Frame 7, X = 2
6161 Frame 13, X = 255
6162 @end smallexample
6163
6164 @node tdump
6165 @subsection @code{tdump}
6166 @kindex tdump
6167 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
6168 @cindex tracepoint data, display
6169
6170 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
6171 the current trace snapshot.
6172
6173 @smallexample
6174 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
6175 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6176 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
6177 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
6178 > end
6179
6180 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6181
6182 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
6183 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
6184 at gdb_test.c:444
6185 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
6186
6187 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
6188 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
6189 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
6190 d1 0x18 24
6191 d2 0x80 128
6192 d3 0x33 51
6193 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
6194 d5 0x22 34
6195 d6 0xe0 224
6196 d7 0x380035 3670069
6197 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
6198 a1 0x3000668 50333288
6199 a2 0x100 256
6200 a3 0x322000 3284992
6201 a4 0x3000698 50333336
6202 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
6203 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
6204 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
6205 ps 0x0 0
6206 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
6207 fpcontrol 0x0 0
6208 fpstatus 0x0 0
6209 fpiaddr 0x0 0
6210 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
6211 p1 = (void *) 0x11
6212 p2 = (void *) 0x22
6213 p3 = (void *) 0x33
6214 p4 = (void *) 0x44
6215 p5 = (void *) 0x55
6216 p6 = (void *) 0x66
6217 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
6218
6219 (@value{GDBP})
6220 @end smallexample
6221
6222 @node save-tracepoints
6223 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
6224 @kindex save-tracepoints
6225 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
6226
6227 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
6228 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
6229 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
6230 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
6231 Files}).
6232
6233 @node Tracepoint Variables
6234 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
6235 @cindex tracepoint variables
6236 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
6237
6238 @table @code
6239 @vindex $trace_frame
6240 @item (int) $trace_frame
6241 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
6242 snapshot is selected.
6243
6244 @vindex $tracepoint
6245 @item (int) $tracepoint
6246 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
6247
6248 @vindex $trace_line
6249 @item (int) $trace_line
6250 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
6251
6252 @vindex $trace_file
6253 @item (char []) $trace_file
6254 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
6255
6256 @vindex $trace_func
6257 @item (char []) $trace_func
6258 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
6259 @end table
6260
6261 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
6262 use @code{output} instead.
6263
6264 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
6265 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
6266 data.
6267
6268 @smallexample
6269 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6270
6271 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
6272 > output $trace_file
6273 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
6274 > tfind
6275 > end
6276 @end smallexample
6277
6278 @node Languages
6279 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
6280 @cindex languages
6281
6282 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
6283 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
6284 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
6285 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
6286 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
6287 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
6288
6289 @cindex working language
6290 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
6291 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
6292 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
6293 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
6294 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
6295 language}.
6296
6297 @menu
6298 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
6299 * Show:: Displaying the language
6300 * Checks:: Type and range checks
6301 * Support:: Supported languages
6302 @end menu
6303
6304 @node Setting
6305 @section Switching between source languages
6306
6307 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
6308 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
6309 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
6310 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
6311 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
6312 are printed, etc.
6313
6314 In addition to the working language, every source file that
6315 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
6316 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
6317 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
6318 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
6319 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
6320 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
6321 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
6322 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
6323 Displaying the language}.
6324
6325 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
6326 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
6327 another language. In that case, make the
6328 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
6329 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
6330 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
6331
6332 @menu
6333 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
6334 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
6335 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
6336 @end menu
6337
6338 @node Filenames
6339 @subsection List of filename extensions and languages
6340
6341 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
6342 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
6343
6344 @table @file
6345
6346 @item .c
6347 C source file
6348
6349 @item .C
6350 @itemx .cc
6351 @itemx .cp
6352 @itemx .cpp
6353 @itemx .cxx
6354 @itemx .c++
6355 C@t{++} source file
6356
6357 @item .f
6358 @itemx .F
6359 Fortran source file
6360
6361 @item .ch
6362 @itemx .c186
6363 @itemx .c286
6364 CHILL source file
6365
6366 @item .mod
6367 Modula-2 source file
6368
6369 @item .s
6370 @itemx .S
6371 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
6372 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
6373 @end table
6374
6375 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
6376 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
6377
6378 @node Manually
6379 @subsection Setting the working language
6380
6381 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
6382 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
6383 your program.
6384
6385 @kindex set language
6386 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
6387 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
6388 a language, such as
6389 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
6390 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
6391
6392 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
6393 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
6394 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
6395 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
6396 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
6397 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
6398 command such as:
6399
6400 @example
6401 print a = b + c
6402 @end example
6403
6404 @noindent
6405 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
6406 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
6407 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
6408 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
6409
6410 @node Automatically
6411 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
6412
6413 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
6414 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
6415 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
6416 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
6417 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
6418 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
6419 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
6420 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
6421 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
6422
6423 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
6424 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
6425 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
6426 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
6427 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
6428
6429 @node Show
6430 @section Displaying the language
6431
6432 The following commands help you find out which language is the
6433 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
6434
6435 @kindex show language
6436 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
6437 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
6438 @table @code
6439 @item show language
6440 Display the current working language. This is the
6441 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
6442 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
6443
6444 @item info frame
6445 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
6446 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
6447 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
6448 information listed here.
6449
6450 @item info source
6451 Display the source language of this source file.
6452 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
6453 information listed here.
6454 @end table
6455
6456 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
6457 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
6458 with a language explicitly:
6459
6460 @kindex set extension-language
6461 @kindex info extensions
6462 @table @code
6463 @item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
6464 Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
6465 the source language @var{language}.
6466
6467 @item info extensions
6468 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
6469 @end table
6470
6471 @node Checks
6472 @section Type and range checking
6473
6474 @quotation
6475 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
6476 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
6477 section documents the intended facilities.
6478 @end quotation
6479 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
6480
6481 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
6482 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
6483 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
6484 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
6485 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
6486 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
6487 errors when your program is running.
6488
6489 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
6490 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
6491 can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
6492 the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
6493 @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
6494 your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
6495 for the default settings of supported languages.
6496
6497 @menu
6498 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
6499 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
6500 @end menu
6501
6502 @cindex type checking
6503 @cindex checks, type
6504 @node Type Checking
6505 @subsection An overview of type checking
6506
6507 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
6508 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
6509 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
6510 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
6511
6512 @smallexample
6513 1 + 2 @result{} 3
6514 @exdent but
6515 @error{} 1 + 2.3
6516 @end smallexample
6517
6518 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
6519 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
6520
6521 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
6522 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
6523 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
6524 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
6525 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
6526 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
6527 also issues a warning.
6528
6529 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
6530 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
6531 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
6532 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
6533 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
6534 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
6535
6536 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
6537 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
6538 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
6539 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
6540 operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
6541 details on specific languages.
6542
6543 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
6544
6545 @kindex set check@r{, type}
6546 @kindex set check type
6547 @kindex show check type
6548 @table @code
6549 @item set check type auto
6550 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
6551 @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
6552 each language.
6553
6554 @item set check type on
6555 @itemx set check type off
6556 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
6557 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
6558 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
6559 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
6560 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
6561
6562 @item set check type warn
6563 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
6564 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
6565 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
6566 numbers and structures.
6567
6568 @item show type
6569 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
6570 is setting it automatically.
6571 @end table
6572
6573 @cindex range checking
6574 @cindex checks, range
6575 @node Range Checking
6576 @subsection An overview of range checking
6577
6578 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
6579 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
6580 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
6581 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
6582 not exceed the bounds of the array.
6583
6584 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
6585 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
6586 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
6587 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
6588
6589 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
6590 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
6591 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
6592 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
6593 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
6594 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
6595
6596 @example
6597 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
6598 @end example
6599
6600 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
6601 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
6602 Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
6603
6604 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
6605
6606 @kindex set check@r{, range}
6607 @kindex set check range
6608 @kindex show check range
6609 @table @code
6610 @item set check range auto
6611 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
6612 @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
6613 each language.
6614
6615 @item set check range on
6616 @itemx set check range off
6617 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
6618 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
6619 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
6620 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
6621
6622 @item set check range warn
6623 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
6624 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
6625 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
6626 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
6627 systems).
6628
6629 @item show range
6630 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
6631 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
6632 @end table
6633
6634 @node Support
6635 @section Supported languages
6636
6637 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Fortran, Java, Chill, assembly, and Modula-2.
6638 @c This is false ...
6639 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
6640 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
6641 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
6642 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
6643 language.
6644
6645 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
6646 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
6647 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
6648 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
6649 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
6650 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
6651 language reference or tutorial.
6652
6653 @menu
6654 * C:: C and C@t{++}
6655 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
6656 * Chill:: Chill
6657 @end menu
6658
6659 @node C
6660 @subsection C and C@t{++}
6661
6662 @cindex C and C@t{++}
6663 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
6664
6665 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
6666 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
6667 together.
6668
6669 @cindex C@t{++}
6670 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
6671 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
6672 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
6673 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
6674 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
6675 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
6676 compiler (@code{aCC}).
6677
6678 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the stabs debugging
6679 format. You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
6680 command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}. See
6681 @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
6682 CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
6683
6684 @menu
6685 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
6686 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
6687 * C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
6688 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
6689 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
6690 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
6691 * Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
6692 @end menu
6693
6694 @node C Operators
6695 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
6696
6697 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
6698
6699 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
6700 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
6701 often defined on groups of types.
6702
6703 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
6704
6705 @itemize @bullet
6706
6707 @item
6708 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
6709 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
6710
6711 @item
6712 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
6713 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
6714
6715 @item
6716 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
6717
6718 @item
6719 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
6720
6721 @end itemize
6722
6723 @noindent
6724 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
6725 in order of increasing precedence:
6726
6727 @table @code
6728 @item ,
6729 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
6730 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
6731 expression being the last expression evaluated.
6732
6733 @item =
6734 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
6735 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
6736
6737 @item @var{op}=
6738 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
6739 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
6740 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
6741 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
6742 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
6743
6744 @item ?:
6745 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
6746 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
6747 integral type.
6748
6749 @item ||
6750 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
6751
6752 @item &&
6753 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
6754
6755 @item |
6756 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
6757
6758 @item ^
6759 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
6760
6761 @item &
6762 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
6763
6764 @item ==@r{, }!=
6765 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
6766 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
6767
6768 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
6769 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
6770 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
6771 and non-zero for true.
6772
6773 @item <<@r{, }>>
6774 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
6775
6776 @item @@
6777 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
6778
6779 @item +@r{, }-
6780 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
6781 pointer types.
6782
6783 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
6784 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
6785 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
6786 integral types.
6787
6788 @item ++@r{, }--
6789 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
6790 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
6791 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
6792 operation takes place.
6793
6794 @item *
6795 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
6796 @code{++}.
6797
6798 @item &
6799 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
6800
6801 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
6802 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
6803 (or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
6804 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
6805 stored.
6806
6807 @item -
6808 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
6809 precedence as @code{++}.
6810
6811 @item !
6812 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
6813 @code{++}.
6814
6815 @item ~
6816 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
6817 @code{++}.
6818
6819
6820 @item .@r{, }->
6821 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
6822 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
6823 pointer based on the stored type information.
6824 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
6825
6826 @item .*@r{, }->*
6827 Dereferences of pointers to members.
6828
6829 @item []
6830 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
6831 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
6832
6833 @item ()
6834 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
6835
6836 @item ::
6837 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
6838 and @code{class} types.
6839
6840 @item ::
6841 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
6842 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
6843 above.
6844 @end table
6845
6846 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
6847 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
6848 predefined meaning.
6849
6850 @menu
6851 * C Constants::
6852 @end menu
6853
6854 @node C Constants
6855 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
6856
6857 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
6858
6859 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
6860 following ways:
6861
6862 @itemize @bullet
6863 @item
6864 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
6865 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e. zero), and hexadecimal constants by
6866 a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
6867 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
6868 @code{long} value.
6869
6870 @item
6871 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
6872 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
6873 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
6874 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
6875 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
6876 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
6877 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
6878 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
6879 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
6880 constant.
6881
6882 @item
6883 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
6884 integral equivalents.
6885
6886 @item
6887 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
6888 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
6889 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
6890 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
6891 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
6892 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
6893 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
6894 @samp{\n} for newline.
6895
6896 @item
6897 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
6898 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
6899 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
6900 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
6901 characters.
6902
6903 @item
6904 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
6905 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
6906
6907 @item
6908 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
6909 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
6910 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
6911 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
6912 @end itemize
6913
6914 @menu
6915 * C plus plus expressions::
6916 * C Defaults::
6917 * C Checks::
6918
6919 * Debugging C::
6920 @end menu
6921
6922 @node C plus plus expressions
6923 @subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
6924
6925 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
6926 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
6927
6928 @cindex C@t{++} support, not in @sc{coff}
6929 @cindex @sc{coff} versus C@t{++}
6930 @cindex C@t{++} and object formats
6931 @cindex object formats and C@t{++}
6932 @cindex a.out and C@t{++}
6933 @cindex @sc{ecoff} and C@t{++}
6934 @cindex @sc{xcoff} and C@t{++}
6935 @cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C@t{++}
6936 @cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C@t{++}
6937 @c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
6938 @c periodically whether this has happened...
6939 @quotation
6940 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
6941 proper compiler. Typically, C@t{++} debugging depends on the use of
6942 additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
6943 special support. In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
6944 @sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
6945 symbol table, these facilities are all available. (With @sc{gnu} CC,
6946 you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
6947 extensions explicitly.) Where the object code format is standard
6948 @sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C@t{++}
6949 support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
6950 @end quotation
6951
6952 @enumerate
6953
6954 @cindex member functions
6955 @item
6956 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
6957
6958 @example
6959 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
6960 @end example
6961
6962 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
6963 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
6964 @item
6965 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
6966 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
6967 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
6968 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
6969
6970 @cindex call overloaded functions
6971 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
6972 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
6973 @item
6974 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
6975 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
6976 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
6977 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
6978 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
6979 default arguments.
6980
6981 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
6982 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
6983 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
6984 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
6985 number of function arguments.
6986
6987 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
6988 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
6989 ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
6990
6991 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
6992 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
6993 @smallexample
6994 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
6995 @end smallexample
6996
6997 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
6998 see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
6999
7000 @cindex reference declarations
7001 @item
7002 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
7003 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
7004 dereferenced.
7005
7006 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
7007 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
7008 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
7009 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
7010 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
7011
7012 @item
7013 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
7014 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
7015 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
7016 necessary, for example in an expression like
7017 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
7018 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
7019 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
7020 @end enumerate
7021
7022 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
7023 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
7024 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
7025 invoking user-defined operators.
7026
7027 @node C Defaults
7028 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
7029
7030 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
7031
7032 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
7033 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
7034 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
7035 selects the working language.
7036
7037 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
7038 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
7039 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
7040 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
7041 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
7042 for further details.
7043
7044 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
7045 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
7046 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
7047
7048 @node C Checks
7049 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
7050
7051 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
7052
7053 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
7054 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
7055 considers two variables type equivalent if:
7056
7057 @itemize @bullet
7058 @item
7059 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
7060 enumerated tag.
7061
7062 @item
7063 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
7064 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
7065
7066 @ignore
7067 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
7068 @c FIXME--beers?
7069 @item
7070 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
7071 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
7072 compilers.)
7073 @end ignore
7074 @end itemize
7075
7076 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
7077 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
7078 that is not itself an array.
7079
7080 @node Debugging C
7081 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
7082
7083 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
7084 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
7085 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
7086 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
7087
7088 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
7089 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
7090 ,Expressions}.
7091
7092 @menu
7093 * Debugging C plus plus::
7094 @end menu
7095
7096 @node Debugging C plus plus
7097 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
7098
7099 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
7100
7101 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
7102 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
7103
7104 @table @code
7105 @cindex break in overloaded functions
7106 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
7107 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
7108 @value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
7109 you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
7110
7111 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
7112 @item rbreak @var{regex}
7113 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
7114 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
7115 classes.
7116 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
7117
7118 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
7119 @item catch throw
7120 @itemx catch catch
7121 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
7122 Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
7123
7124 @cindex inheritance
7125 @item ptype @var{typename}
7126 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
7127 @var{typename}.
7128 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
7129
7130 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
7131 @item set print demangle
7132 @itemx show print demangle
7133 @itemx set print asm-demangle
7134 @itemx show print asm-demangle
7135 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
7136 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
7137 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
7138
7139 @item set print object
7140 @itemx show print object
7141 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
7142 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
7143
7144 @item set print vtbl
7145 @itemx show print vtbl
7146 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
7147 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
7148 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
7149 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
7150
7151 @kindex set overload-resolution
7152 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
7153 @item set overload-resolution on
7154 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
7155 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
7156 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
7157 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
7158 expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
7159 message.
7160
7161 @item set overload-resolution off
7162 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
7163 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
7164 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
7165 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
7166 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
7167 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
7168 argument types.
7169
7170 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
7171 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
7172 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
7173 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
7174 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
7175 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
7176 @xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
7177 @end table
7178
7179 @node Modula-2
7180 @subsection Modula-2
7181
7182 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
7183
7184 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
7185 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
7186 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
7187 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
7188 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
7189 table.
7190
7191 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
7192 @menu
7193 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
7194 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
7195 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
7196 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
7197 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
7198 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
7199 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
7200 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
7201 @end menu
7202
7203 @node M2 Operators
7204 @subsubsection Operators
7205 @cindex Modula-2 operators
7206
7207 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7208 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
7209 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
7210 following definitions hold:
7211
7212 @itemize @bullet
7213
7214 @item
7215 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
7216 their subranges.
7217
7218 @item
7219 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
7220
7221 @item
7222 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
7223
7224 @item
7225 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
7226 @var{type}}.
7227
7228 @item
7229 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
7230
7231 @item
7232 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
7233
7234 @item
7235 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
7236 @end itemize
7237
7238 @noindent
7239 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
7240 increasing precedence:
7241
7242 @table @code
7243 @item ,
7244 Function argument or array index separator.
7245
7246 @item :=
7247 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
7248 @var{value}.
7249
7250 @item <@r{, }>
7251 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
7252 types.
7253
7254 @item <=@r{, }>=
7255 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
7256 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
7257 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
7258
7259 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
7260 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
7261 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
7262 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
7263 comment character.
7264
7265 @item IN
7266 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
7267 Same precedence as @code{<}.
7268
7269 @item OR
7270 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
7271
7272 @item AND@r{, }&
7273 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
7274
7275 @item @@
7276 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
7277
7278 @item +@r{, }-
7279 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
7280 and difference on set types.
7281
7282 @item *
7283 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
7284 on set types.
7285
7286 @item /
7287 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
7288 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
7289
7290 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
7291 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
7292 precedence as @code{*}.
7293
7294 @item -
7295 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
7296
7297 @item ^
7298 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
7299
7300 @item NOT
7301 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
7302 @code{^}.
7303
7304 @item .
7305 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
7306 precedence as @code{^}.
7307
7308 @item []
7309 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
7310
7311 @item ()
7312 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
7313 as @code{^}.
7314
7315 @item ::@r{, }.
7316 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
7317 @end table
7318
7319 @quotation
7320 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
7321 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
7322 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
7323 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
7324 @end quotation
7325
7326
7327 @node Built-In Func/Proc
7328 @subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
7329 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
7330
7331 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
7332 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
7333
7334 @table @var
7335
7336 @item a
7337 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
7338
7339 @item c
7340 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
7341
7342 @item i
7343 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
7344
7345 @item m
7346 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
7347 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
7348 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
7349
7350 @item n
7351 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
7352
7353 @item r
7354 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
7355
7356 @item t
7357 represents a type.
7358
7359 @item v
7360 represents a variable.
7361
7362 @item x
7363 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
7364 explanation of the function for details.
7365 @end table
7366
7367 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
7368
7369 @table @code
7370 @item ABS(@var{n})
7371 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
7372
7373 @item CAP(@var{c})
7374 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
7375 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
7376
7377 @item CHR(@var{i})
7378 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
7379
7380 @item DEC(@var{v})
7381 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
7382
7383 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
7384 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
7385 new value.
7386
7387 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
7388 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
7389 set.
7390
7391 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
7392 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
7393
7394 @item HIGH(@var{a})
7395 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
7396
7397 @item INC(@var{v})
7398 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
7399
7400 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
7401 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
7402 new value.
7403
7404 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
7405 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
7406 there. Returns the new set.
7407
7408 @item MAX(@var{t})
7409 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
7410
7411 @item MIN(@var{t})
7412 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
7413
7414 @item ODD(@var{i})
7415 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
7416
7417 @item ORD(@var{x})
7418 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
7419 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
7420 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
7421 integral, character and enumerated types.
7422
7423 @item SIZE(@var{x})
7424 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
7425
7426 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
7427 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
7428
7429 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
7430 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
7431 @end table
7432
7433 @quotation
7434 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
7435 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
7436 an error.
7437 @end quotation
7438
7439 @cindex Modula-2 constants
7440 @node M2 Constants
7441 @subsubsection Constants
7442
7443 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
7444 ways:
7445
7446 @itemize @bullet
7447
7448 @item
7449 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
7450 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
7451 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
7452 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
7453
7454 @item
7455 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
7456 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
7457 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
7458 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
7459 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
7460 digits.
7461
7462 @item
7463 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
7464 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
7465 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
7466 followed by a @samp{C}.
7467
7468 @item
7469 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
7470 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
7471 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
7472 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
7473 sequences.
7474
7475 @item
7476 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
7477
7478 @item
7479 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
7480 @code{FALSE}.
7481
7482 @item
7483 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
7484
7485 @item
7486 Set constants are not yet supported.
7487 @end itemize
7488
7489 @node M2 Defaults
7490 @subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
7491 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
7492
7493 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
7494 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
7495 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
7496 selected the working language.
7497
7498 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
7499 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
7500 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
7501 the language automatically}, for further details.
7502
7503 @node Deviations
7504 @subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
7505 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
7506
7507 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
7508 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
7509
7510 @itemize @bullet
7511 @item
7512 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
7513 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
7514 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
7515 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
7516 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
7517 returned a pointer.)
7518
7519 @item
7520 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
7521 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
7522 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
7523 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
7524
7525 @item
7526 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
7527 argument.
7528
7529 @item
7530 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
7531 @end itemize
7532
7533 @node M2 Checks
7534 @subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
7535 @cindex Modula-2 checks
7536
7537 @quotation
7538 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
7539 range checking.
7540 @end quotation
7541 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
7542
7543 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
7544
7545 @itemize @bullet
7546 @item
7547 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
7548 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
7549
7550 @item
7551 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
7552 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
7553 @end itemize
7554
7555 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
7556 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
7557
7558 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
7559 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
7560
7561 @node M2 Scope
7562 @subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
7563 @cindex scope
7564 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
7565 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
7566 @ifinfo
7567 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
7568 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
7569 @end ifinfo
7570 @iftex
7571 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
7572 @end iftex
7573
7574 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
7575 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
7576 similar syntax:
7577
7578 @example
7579
7580 @var{module} . @var{id}
7581 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
7582 @end example
7583
7584 @noindent
7585 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
7586 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
7587 identifier within your program, except another module.
7588
7589 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
7590 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
7591 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
7592 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
7593
7594 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
7595 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
7596 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
7597 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
7598 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
7599 @var{module}.
7600
7601 @node GDB/M2
7602 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
7603
7604 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
7605 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
7606 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
7607 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
7608 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
7609 analogue in Modula-2.
7610
7611 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
7612 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
7613 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
7614 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
7615 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
7616 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
7617
7618 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
7619 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
7620 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
7621
7622 @node Chill
7623 @subsection Chill
7624
7625 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Chill only support output
7626 from the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler. Other Chill compilers are not currently
7627 supported, and attempting to debug executables produced by them is most
7628 likely to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
7629 table.
7630
7631 @c This used to say "... following Chill related topics ...", but since
7632 @c menus are not shown in the printed manual, it would look awkward.
7633 This section covers the Chill related topics and the features
7634 of @value{GDBN} which support these topics.
7635
7636 @menu
7637 * How modes are displayed:: How modes are displayed
7638 * Locations:: Locations and their accesses
7639 * Values and their Operations:: Values and their Operations
7640 * Chill type and range checks::
7641 * Chill defaults::
7642 @end menu
7643
7644 @node How modes are displayed
7645 @subsubsection How modes are displayed
7646
7647 The Chill Datatype- (Mode) support of @value{GDBN} is directly related
7648 with the functionality of the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler, and therefore deviates
7649 slightly from the standard specification of the Chill language. The
7650 provided modes are:
7651
7652 @c FIXME: this @table's contents effectively disable @code by using @r
7653 @c on every @item. So why does it need @code?
7654 @table @code
7655 @item @r{@emph{Discrete modes:}}
7656 @itemize @bullet
7657 @item
7658 @emph{Integer Modes} which are predefined by @code{BYTE, UBYTE, INT,
7659 UINT, LONG, ULONG},
7660 @item
7661 @emph{Boolean Mode} which is predefined by @code{BOOL},
7662 @item
7663 @emph{Character Mode} which is predefined by @code{CHAR},
7664 @item
7665 @emph{Set Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{SET}.
7666 @smallexample
7667 (@value{GDBP}) ptype x
7668 type = SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
7669 @end smallexample
7670 If the type is an unnumbered set the set element values are omitted.
7671 @item
7672 @emph{Range Mode} which is displayed by
7673 @smallexample
7674 @code{type = <basemode>(<lower bound> : <upper bound>)}
7675 @end smallexample
7676 where @code{<lower bound>, <upper bound>} can be of any discrete literal
7677 expression (e.g. set element names).
7678 @end itemize
7679
7680 @item @r{@emph{Powerset Mode:}}
7681 A Powerset Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{POWERSET} followed by
7682 the member mode of the powerset. The member mode can be any discrete mode.
7683 @smallexample
7684 (@value{GDBP}) ptype x
7685 type = POWERSET SET (egon, hugo, otto)
7686 @end smallexample
7687
7688 @item @r{@emph{Reference Modes:}}
7689 @itemize @bullet
7690 @item
7691 @emph{Bound Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{REF}
7692 followed by the mode name to which the reference is bound.
7693 @item
7694 @emph{Free Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{PTR}.
7695 @end itemize
7696
7697 @item @r{@emph{Procedure mode}}
7698 The procedure mode is displayed by @code{type = PROC(<parameter list>)
7699 <return mode> EXCEPTIONS (<exception list>)}. The @code{<parameter
7700 list>} is a list of the parameter modes. @code{<return mode>} indicates
7701 the mode of the result of the procedure if any. The exceptionlist lists
7702 all possible exceptions which can be raised by the procedure.
7703
7704 @ignore
7705 @item @r{@emph{Instance mode}}
7706 The instance mode is represented by a structure, which has a static
7707 type, and is therefore not really of interest.
7708 @end ignore
7709
7710 @item @r{@emph{Synchronization Modes:}}
7711 @itemize @bullet
7712 @item
7713 @emph{Event Mode} which is displayed by
7714 @smallexample
7715 @code{EVENT (<event length>)}
7716 @end smallexample
7717 where @code{(<event length>)} is optional.
7718 @item
7719 @emph{Buffer Mode} which is displayed by
7720 @smallexample
7721 @code{BUFFER (<buffer length>)<buffer element mode>}
7722 @end smallexample
7723 where @code{(<buffer length>)} is optional.
7724 @end itemize
7725
7726 @item @r{@emph{Timing Modes:}}
7727 @itemize @bullet
7728 @item
7729 @emph{Duration Mode} which is predefined by @code{DURATION}
7730 @item
7731 @emph{Absolute Time Mode} which is predefined by @code{TIME}
7732 @end itemize
7733
7734 @item @r{@emph{Real Modes:}}
7735 Real Modes are predefined with @code{REAL} and @code{LONG_REAL}.
7736
7737 @item @r{@emph{String Modes:}}
7738 @itemize @bullet
7739 @item
7740 @emph{Character String Mode} which is displayed by
7741 @smallexample
7742 @code{CHARS(<string length>)}
7743 @end smallexample
7744 followed by the keyword @code{VARYING} if the String Mode is a varying
7745 mode
7746 @item
7747 @emph{Bit String Mode} which is displayed by
7748 @smallexample
7749 @code{BOOLS(<string
7750 length>)}
7751 @end smallexample
7752 @end itemize
7753
7754 @item @r{@emph{Array Mode:}}
7755 The Array Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{ARRAY(<range>)}
7756 followed by the element mode (which may in turn be an array mode).
7757 @smallexample
7758 (@value{GDBP}) ptype x
7759 type = ARRAY (1:42)
7760 ARRAY (1:20)
7761 SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
7762 @end smallexample
7763
7764 @item @r{@emph{Structure Mode}}
7765 The Structure mode is displayed by the keyword @code{STRUCT(<field
7766 list>)}. The @code{<field list>} consists of names and modes of fields
7767 of the structure. Variant structures have the keyword @code{CASE <field>
7768 OF <variant fields> ESAC} in their field list. Since the current version
7769 of the GNU Chill compiler doesn't implement tag processing (no runtime
7770 checks of variant fields, and therefore no debugging info), the output
7771 always displays all variant fields.
7772 @smallexample
7773 (@value{GDBP}) ptype str
7774 type = STRUCT (
7775 as x,
7776 bs x,
7777 CASE bs OF
7778 (karli):
7779 cs a
7780 (ott):
7781 ds x
7782 ESAC
7783 )
7784 @end smallexample
7785 @end table
7786
7787 @node Locations
7788 @subsubsection Locations and their accesses
7789
7790 A location in Chill is an object which can contain values.
7791
7792 A value of a location is generally accessed by the (declared) name of
7793 the location. The output conforms to the specification of values in
7794 Chill programs. How values are specified
7795 is the topic of the next section, @ref{Values and their Operations}.
7796
7797 The pseudo-location @code{RESULT} (or @code{result}) can be used to
7798 display or change the result of a currently-active procedure:
7799
7800 @smallexample
7801 set result := EXPR
7802 @end smallexample
7803
7804 @noindent
7805 This does the same as the Chill action @code{RESULT EXPR} (which
7806 is not available in @value{GDBN}).
7807
7808 Values of reference mode locations are printed by @code{PTR(<hex
7809 value>)} in case of a free reference mode, and by @code{(REF <reference
7810 mode>) (<hex-value>)} in case of a bound reference. @code{<hex value>}
7811 represents the address where the reference points to. To access the
7812 value of the location referenced by the pointer, use the dereference
7813 operator @samp{->}.
7814
7815 Values of procedure mode locations are displayed by
7816 @smallexample
7817 @code{@{ PROC
7818 (<argument modes> ) <return mode> @} <address> <name of procedure
7819 location>}
7820 @end smallexample
7821 @code{<argument modes>} is a list of modes according to the parameter
7822 specification of the procedure and @code{<address>} shows the address of
7823 the entry point.
7824
7825 @ignore
7826 Locations of instance modes are displayed just like a structure with two
7827 fields specifying the @emph{process type} and the @emph{copy number} of
7828 the investigated instance location@footnote{This comes from the current
7829 implementation of instances. They are implemented as a structure (no
7830 na). The output should be something like @code{[<name of the process>;
7831 <instance number>]}.}. The field names are @code{__proc_type} and
7832 @code{__proc_copy}.
7833
7834 Locations of synchronization modes are displayed like a structure with
7835 the field name @code{__event_data} in case of a event mode location, and
7836 like a structure with the field @code{__buffer_data} in case of a buffer
7837 mode location (refer to previous paragraph).
7838
7839 Structure Mode locations are printed by @code{[.<field name>: <value>,
7840 ...]}. The @code{<field name>} corresponds to the structure mode
7841 definition and the layout of @code{<value>} varies depending of the mode
7842 of the field. If the investigated structure mode location is of variant
7843 structure mode, the variant parts of the structure are enclosed in curled
7844 braces (@samp{@{@}}). Fields enclosed by @samp{@{,@}} are residing
7845 on the same memory location and represent the current values of the
7846 memory location in their specific modes. Since no tag processing is done
7847 all variants are displayed. A variant field is printed by
7848 @code{(<variant name>) = .<field name>: <value>}. (who implements the
7849 stuff ???)
7850 @smallexample
7851 (@value{GDBP}) print str1 $4 = [.as: 0, .bs: karli, .<TAG>: { (karli) =
7852 [.cs: []], (susi) = [.ds: susi]}]
7853 @end smallexample
7854 @end ignore
7855
7856 Substructures of string mode-, array mode- or structure mode-values
7857 (e.g. array slices, fields of structure locations) are accessed using
7858 certain operations which are described in the next section, @ref{Values
7859 and their Operations}.
7860
7861 A location value may be interpreted as having a different mode using the
7862 location conversion. This mode conversion is written as @code{<mode
7863 name>(<location>)}. The user has to consider that the sizes of the modes
7864 have to be equal otherwise an error occurs. Furthermore, no range
7865 checking of the location against the destination mode is performed, and
7866 therefore the result can be quite confusing.
7867
7868 @smallexample
7869 (@value{GDBP}) print int (s(3 up 4)) XXX TO be filled in !! XXX
7870 @end smallexample
7871
7872 @node Values and their Operations
7873 @subsubsection Values and their Operations
7874
7875 Values are used to alter locations, to investigate complex structures in
7876 more detail or to filter relevant information out of a large amount of
7877 data. There are several (mode dependent) operations defined which enable
7878 such investigations. These operations are not only applicable to
7879 constant values but also to locations, which can become quite useful
7880 when debugging complex structures. During parsing the command line
7881 (e.g. evaluating an expression) @value{GDBN} treats location names as
7882 the values behind these locations.
7883
7884 This section describes how values have to be specified and which
7885 operations are legal to be used with such values.
7886
7887 @table @code
7888 @item Literal Values
7889 Literal values are specified in the same manner as in @sc{gnu} Chill programs.
7890 For detailed specification refer to the @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual
7891 chapter 1.5.
7892 @c FIXME: if the Chill Manual is a Texinfo documents, the above should
7893 @c be converted to a @ref.
7894
7895 @ignore
7896 @itemize @bullet
7897 @item
7898 @emph{Integer Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
7899 programs (refer to the Chill Standard z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.2)
7900 @item
7901 @emph{Boolean Literals} are defined by @code{TRUE} and @code{FALSE}.
7902 @item
7903 @emph{Character Literals} are defined by @code{'<character>'}. (e.g.
7904 @code{'M'})
7905 @item
7906 @emph{Set Literals} are defined by a name which was specified in a set
7907 mode. The value delivered by a Set Literal is the set value. This is
7908 comparable to an enumeration in C/C@t{++} language.
7909 @item
7910 @emph{Emptiness Literal} is predefined by @code{NULL}. The value of the
7911 emptiness literal delivers either the empty reference value, the empty
7912 procedure value or the empty instance value.
7913
7914 @item
7915 @emph{Character String Literals} are defined by a sequence of characters
7916 enclosed in single- or double quotes. If a single- or double quote has
7917 to be part of the string literal it has to be stuffed (specified twice).
7918 @item
7919 @emph{Bitstring Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
7920 programs (refer z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.8).
7921 @item
7922 @emph{Floating point literals} are specified in the same manner as in
7923 (gnu-)Chill programs (refer @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual chapter 1.5).
7924 @end itemize
7925 @end ignore
7926
7927 @item Tuple Values
7928 A tuple is specified by @code{<mode name>[<tuple>]}, where @code{<mode
7929 name>} can be omitted if the mode of the tuple is unambiguous. This
7930 unambiguity is derived from the context of a evaluated expression.
7931 @code{<tuple>} can be one of the following:
7932
7933 @itemize @bullet
7934 @item @emph{Powerset Tuple}
7935 @item @emph{Array Tuple}
7936 @item @emph{Structure Tuple}
7937 Powerset tuples, array tuples and structure tuples are specified in the
7938 same manner as in Chill programs refer to z200/88 chpt 5.2.5.
7939 @end itemize
7940
7941 @item String Element Value
7942 A string element value is specified by
7943 @smallexample
7944 @code{<string value>(<index>)}
7945 @end smallexample
7946 where @code{<index>} is a integer expression. It delivers a character
7947 value which is equivalent to the character indexed by @code{<index>} in
7948 the string.
7949
7950 @item String Slice Value
7951 A string slice value is specified by @code{<string value>(<slice
7952 spec>)}, where @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range of integer
7953 expressions or specified by @code{<start expr> up <size>}.
7954 @code{<size>} denotes the number of elements which the slice contains.
7955 The delivered value is a string value, which is part of the specified
7956 string.
7957
7958 @item Array Element Values
7959 An array element value is specified by @code{<array value>(<expr>)} and
7960 delivers a array element value of the mode of the specified array.
7961
7962 @item Array Slice Values
7963 An array slice is specified by @code{<array value>(<slice spec>)}, where
7964 @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range specified by expressions or by
7965 @code{<start expr> up <size>}. @code{<size>} denotes the number of
7966 arrayelements the slice contains. The delivered value is an array value
7967 which is part of the specified array.
7968
7969 @item Structure Field Values
7970 A structure field value is derived by @code{<structure value>.<field
7971 name>}, where @code{<field name>} indicates the name of a field specified
7972 in the mode definition of the structure. The mode of the delivered value
7973 corresponds to this mode definition in the structure definition.
7974
7975 @item Procedure Call Value
7976 The procedure call value is derived from the return value of the
7977 procedure@footnote{If a procedure call is used for instance in an
7978 expression, then this procedure is called with all its side
7979 effects. This can lead to confusing results if used carelessly.}.
7980
7981 Values of duration mode locations are represented by @code{ULONG} literals.
7982
7983 Values of time mode locations appear as
7984 @smallexample
7985 @code{TIME(<secs>:<nsecs>)}
7986 @end smallexample
7987
7988
7989 @ignore
7990 This is not implemented yet:
7991 @item Built-in Value
7992 @noindent
7993 The following built in functions are provided:
7994
7995 @table @code
7996 @item @code{ADDR()}
7997 @item @code{NUM()}
7998 @item @code{PRED()}
7999 @item @code{SUCC()}
8000 @item @code{ABS()}
8001 @item @code{CARD()}
8002 @item @code{MAX()}
8003 @item @code{MIN()}
8004 @item @code{SIZE()}
8005 @item @code{UPPER()}
8006 @item @code{LOWER()}
8007 @item @code{LENGTH()}
8008 @item @code{SIN()}
8009 @item @code{COS()}
8010 @item @code{TAN()}
8011 @item @code{ARCSIN()}
8012 @item @code{ARCCOS()}
8013 @item @code{ARCTAN()}
8014 @item @code{EXP()}
8015 @item @code{LN()}
8016 @item @code{LOG()}
8017 @item @code{SQRT()}
8018 @end table
8019
8020 For a detailed description refer to the GNU Chill implementation manual
8021 chapter 1.6.
8022 @end ignore
8023
8024 @item Zero-adic Operator Value
8025 The zero-adic operator value is derived from the instance value for the
8026 current active process.
8027
8028 @item Expression Values
8029 The value delivered by an expression is the result of the evaluation of
8030 the specified expression. If there are error conditions (mode
8031 incompatibility, etc.) the evaluation of expressions is aborted with a
8032 corresponding error message. Expressions may be parenthesised which
8033 causes the evaluation of this expression before any other expression
8034 which uses the result of the parenthesised expression. The following
8035 operators are supported by @value{GDBN}:
8036
8037 @table @code
8038 @item @code{OR, ORIF, XOR}
8039 @itemx @code{AND, ANDIF}
8040 @itemx @code{NOT}
8041 Logical operators defined over operands of boolean mode.
8042
8043 @item @code{=, /=}
8044 Equality and inequality operators defined over all modes.
8045
8046 @item @code{>, >=}
8047 @itemx @code{<, <=}
8048 Relational operators defined over predefined modes.
8049
8050 @item @code{+, -}
8051 @itemx @code{*, /, MOD, REM}
8052 Arithmetic operators defined over predefined modes.
8053
8054 @item @code{-}
8055 Change sign operator.
8056
8057 @item @code{//}
8058 String concatenation operator.
8059
8060 @item @code{()}
8061 String repetition operator.
8062
8063 @item @code{->}
8064 Referenced location operator which can be used either to take the
8065 address of a location (@code{->loc}), or to dereference a reference
8066 location (@code{loc->}).
8067
8068 @item @code{OR, XOR}
8069 @itemx @code{AND}
8070 @itemx @code{NOT}
8071 Powerset and bitstring operators.
8072
8073 @item @code{>, >=}
8074 @itemx @code{<, <=}
8075 Powerset inclusion operators.
8076
8077 @item @code{IN}
8078 Membership operator.
8079 @end table
8080 @end table
8081
8082 @node Chill type and range checks
8083 @subsubsection Chill type and range checks
8084
8085 @value{GDBN} considers two Chill variables mode equivalent if the sizes
8086 of the two modes are equal. This rule applies recursively to more
8087 complex datatypes which means that complex modes are treated
8088 equivalent if all element modes (which also can be complex modes like
8089 structures, arrays, etc.) have the same size.
8090
8091 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8092 index bounds and all built in procedures.
8093
8094 Strong type checks are forced using the @value{GDBN} command @code{set
8095 check strong}. This enforces strong type and range checks on all
8096 operations where Chill constructs are used (expressions, built in
8097 functions, etc.) in respect to the semantics as defined in the z.200
8098 language specification.
8099
8100 All checks can be disabled by the @value{GDBN} command @code{set check
8101 off}.
8102
8103 @ignore
8104 @c Deviations from the Chill Standard Z200/88
8105 see last paragraph ?
8106 @end ignore
8107
8108 @node Chill defaults
8109 @subsubsection Chill defaults
8110
8111 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8112 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
8113 Chill. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
8114 selected the working language.
8115
8116 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8117 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.ch} sets the
8118 working language to Chill. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
8119 the language automatically}, for further details.
8120
8121 @node Symbols
8122 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
8123
8124 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
8125 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
8126 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
8127 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
8128 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
8129 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
8130 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8131
8132 @cindex symbol names
8133 @cindex names of symbols
8134 @cindex quoting names
8135 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
8136 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
8137 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
8138 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
8139 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
8140 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
8141 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
8142 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
8143
8144 @example
8145 p 'foo.c'::x
8146 @end example
8147
8148 @noindent
8149 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
8150
8151 @table @code
8152 @kindex info address
8153 @cindex address of a symbol
8154 @item info address @var{symbol}
8155 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
8156 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
8157 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
8158 is always stored.
8159
8160 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
8161 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
8162 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
8163
8164 @kindex info symbol
8165 @cindex symbol from address
8166 @item info symbol @var{addr}
8167 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
8168 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
8169 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
8170
8171 @example
8172 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
8173 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
8174 @end example
8175
8176 @noindent
8177 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
8178 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
8179
8180 @kindex whatis
8181 @item whatis @var{expr}
8182 Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
8183 actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
8184 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
8185 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8186
8187 @item whatis
8188 Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8189
8190 @kindex ptype
8191 @item ptype @var{typename}
8192 Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
8193 the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
8194 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
8195 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
8196
8197 @item ptype @var{expr}
8198 @itemx ptype
8199 Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
8200 differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
8201 of just the name of the type.
8202
8203 For example, for this variable declaration:
8204
8205 @example
8206 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
8207 @end example
8208
8209 @noindent
8210 the two commands give this output:
8211
8212 @example
8213 @group
8214 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
8215 type = struct complex
8216 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
8217 type = struct complex @{
8218 double real;
8219 double imag;
8220 @}
8221 @end group
8222 @end example
8223
8224 @noindent
8225 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
8226 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8227
8228 @kindex info types
8229 @item info types @var{regexp}
8230 @itemx info types
8231 Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
8232 (or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
8233 complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
8234 @samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
8235 names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
8236 information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
8237
8238 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
8239 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
8240 lists all source files where a type is defined.
8241
8242 @kindex info scope
8243 @cindex local variables
8244 @item info scope @var{addr}
8245 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
8246 accepts a location---a function name, a source line, or an address
8247 preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local to the
8248 scope defined by that location. For example:
8249
8250 @smallexample
8251 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
8252 Scope for command_line_handler:
8253 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
8254 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
8255 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
8256 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
8257 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
8258 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
8259 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
8260 @end smallexample
8261
8262 @noindent
8263 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
8264 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
8265 collect}.
8266
8267 @kindex info source
8268 @item info source
8269 Show the name of the current source file---that is, the source file for
8270 the function containing the current point of execution---and the language
8271 it was written in.
8272
8273 @kindex info sources
8274 @item info sources
8275 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
8276 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
8277 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
8278
8279 @kindex info functions
8280 @item info functions
8281 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
8282
8283 @item info functions @var{regexp}
8284 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
8285 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
8286 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
8287 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
8288 start with @code{step}.
8289
8290 @kindex info variables
8291 @item info variables
8292 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
8293 outside of functions (i.e., excluding local variables).
8294
8295 @item info variables @var{regexp}
8296 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
8297 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
8298 @var{regexp}.
8299
8300 @ignore
8301 This was never implemented.
8302 @kindex info methods
8303 @item info methods
8304 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
8305 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
8306 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
8307 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
8308 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
8309 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
8310 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
8311 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
8312 @end ignore
8313
8314 @cindex reloading symbols
8315 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
8316 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
8317 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
8318 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
8319 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
8320
8321 @table @code
8322 @kindex set symbol-reloading
8323 @item set symbol-reloading on
8324 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
8325 object file with a particular name is seen again.
8326
8327 @item set symbol-reloading off
8328 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
8329 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
8330 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
8331 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
8332 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
8333 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
8334 name.
8335
8336 @kindex show symbol-reloading
8337 @item show symbol-reloading
8338 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
8339 @end table
8340
8341 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
8342 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
8343 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
8344 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
8345 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
8346 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
8347 another source file. The default is on.
8348
8349 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
8350 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
8351
8352 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
8353 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
8354 is printed as follows:
8355 @smallexample
8356 @{<no data fields>@}
8357 @end smallexample
8358
8359 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
8360 @item show opaque-type-resolution
8361 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
8362
8363 @kindex maint print symbols
8364 @cindex symbol dump
8365 @kindex maint print psymbols
8366 @cindex partial symbol dump
8367 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
8368 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
8369 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
8370 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
8371 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
8372 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
8373 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
8374 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
8375 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
8376 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
8377 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
8378 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
8379 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
8380 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
8381 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
8382 @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
8383 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
8384 @end table
8385
8386 @node Altering
8387 @chapter Altering Execution
8388
8389 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
8390 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
8391 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
8392 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
8393 program.
8394
8395 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
8396 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
8397 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
8398
8399 @menu
8400 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
8401 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
8402 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
8403 * Returning:: Returning from a function
8404 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
8405 * Patching:: Patching your program
8406 @end menu
8407
8408 @node Assignment
8409 @section Assignment to variables
8410
8411 @cindex assignment
8412 @cindex setting variables
8413 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
8414 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
8415
8416 @example
8417 print x=4
8418 @end example
8419
8420 @noindent
8421 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
8422 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
8423 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
8424 information on operators in supported languages.
8425
8426 @kindex set variable
8427 @cindex variables, setting
8428 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
8429 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
8430 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
8431 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
8432 ,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
8433
8434 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
8435 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
8436 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
8437 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
8438 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
8439 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
8440 command @code{set width}:
8441
8442 @example
8443 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
8444 type = double
8445 (@value{GDBP}) p width
8446 $4 = 13
8447 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
8448 Invalid syntax in expression.
8449 @end example
8450
8451 @noindent
8452 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
8453 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
8454
8455 @example
8456 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
8457 @end example
8458
8459 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
8460 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
8461 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
8462 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
8463 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
8464 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
8465
8466 @example
8467 @group
8468 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
8469 type = double
8470 (@value{GDBP}) p g
8471 $1 = 1
8472 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
8473 (@value{GDBP}) p g
8474 $2 = 1
8475 (@value{GDBP}) r
8476 The program being debugged has been started already.
8477 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
8478 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
8479 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
8480 Invalid bfd target.
8481 (@value{GDBP}) show g
8482 The current BFD target is "=4".
8483 @end group
8484 @end example
8485
8486 @noindent
8487 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
8488 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
8489 @code{g}, use
8490
8491 @example
8492 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
8493 @end example
8494
8495 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
8496 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
8497 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
8498 same length or shorter.
8499 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
8500 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
8501
8502 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
8503 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
8504 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
8505 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
8506 and representation in memory), and
8507
8508 @example
8509 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
8510 @end example
8511
8512 @noindent
8513 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
8514
8515 @node Jumping
8516 @section Continuing at a different address
8517
8518 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
8519 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
8520 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
8521
8522 @table @code
8523 @kindex jump
8524 @item jump @var{linespec}
8525 Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
8526 immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
8527 source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
8528 @var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
8529 in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
8530 breakpoints}.
8531
8532 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
8533 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
8534 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
8535 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
8536 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
8537 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
8538 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
8539 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
8540 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
8541
8542 @item jump *@var{address}
8543 Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
8544 @end table
8545
8546 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
8547 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
8548 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
8549 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
8550 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
8551 example,
8552
8553 @example
8554 set $pc = 0x485
8555 @end example
8556
8557 @noindent
8558 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
8559 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
8560 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
8561
8562 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
8563 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
8564 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
8565 detail.
8566
8567 @c @group
8568 @node Signaling
8569 @section Giving your program a signal
8570
8571 @table @code
8572 @kindex signal
8573 @item signal @var{signal}
8574 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
8575 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
8576 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
8577 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
8578
8579 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
8580 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
8581 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
8582 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
8583 signal.
8584
8585 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
8586 after executing the command.
8587 @end table
8588 @c @end group
8589
8590 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
8591 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
8592 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
8593 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
8594 passes the signal directly to your program.
8595
8596
8597 @node Returning
8598 @section Returning from a function
8599
8600 @table @code
8601 @cindex returning from a function
8602 @kindex return
8603 @item return
8604 @itemx return @var{expression}
8605 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
8606 command. If you give an
8607 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
8608 value.
8609 @end table
8610
8611 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
8612 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
8613 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
8614 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
8615
8616 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
8617 frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
8618 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
8619 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
8620 of functions.
8621
8622 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
8623 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
8624 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
8625 and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
8626 selected stack frame returns naturally.
8627
8628 @node Calling
8629 @section Calling program functions
8630
8631 @cindex calling functions
8632 @kindex call
8633 @table @code
8634 @item call @var{expr}
8635 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
8636 returned values.
8637 @end table
8638
8639 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
8640 execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
8641 with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
8642 is printed and saved in the value history.
8643
8644 For the A29K, a user-controlled variable @code{call_scratch_address},
8645 specifies the location of a scratch area to be used when @value{GDBN}
8646 calls a function in the target. This is necessary because the usual
8647 method of putting the scratch area on the stack does not work in systems
8648 that have separate instruction and data spaces.
8649
8650 @node Patching
8651 @section Patching programs
8652
8653 @cindex patching binaries
8654 @cindex writing into executables
8655 @cindex writing into corefiles
8656
8657 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
8658 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
8659 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
8660 patching your program's binary.
8661
8662 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
8663 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
8664 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
8665 repairs.
8666
8667 @table @code
8668 @kindex set write
8669 @item set write on
8670 @itemx set write off
8671 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
8672 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
8673 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
8674
8675 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
8676 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
8677 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
8678
8679 @item show write
8680 @kindex show write
8681 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
8682 as well as reading.
8683 @end table
8684
8685 @node GDB Files
8686 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
8687
8688 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
8689 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
8690 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
8691 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
8692
8693 @menu
8694 * Files:: Commands to specify files
8695 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
8696 @end menu
8697
8698 @node Files
8699 @section Commands to specify files
8700
8701 @cindex symbol table
8702 @cindex core dump file
8703
8704 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
8705 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
8706 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
8707 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
8708
8709 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
8710 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
8711 a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
8712 to specify new files are useful.
8713
8714 @table @code
8715 @cindex executable file
8716 @kindex file
8717 @item file @var{filename}
8718 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
8719 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
8720 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
8721 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
8722 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
8723 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
8724 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
8725 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
8726
8727 On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
8728 @file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
8729 @var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
8730 @file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
8731 descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
8732 (available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
8733 @code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
8734 for more information.
8735
8736 @item file
8737 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
8738 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
8739
8740 @kindex exec-file
8741 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8742 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
8743 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
8744 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
8745 discard information on the executable file.
8746
8747 @kindex symbol-file
8748 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8749 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
8750 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
8751 table and program to run from the same file.
8752
8753 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
8754 program's symbol table.
8755
8756 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
8757 of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
8758 auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
8759 the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
8760 the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
8761
8762 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
8763 executing it once.
8764
8765 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
8766 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
8767 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
8768 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
8769 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
8770 using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
8771 optimized code.
8772
8773 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
8774 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
8775 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
8776 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
8777 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
8778
8779 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
8780 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
8781 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
8782 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
8783 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
8784 warnings and messages}.)
8785
8786 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
8787 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
8788 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
8789 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
8790 in stabs format.
8791
8792 @kindex readnow
8793 @cindex reading symbols immediately
8794 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
8795 @kindex mapped
8796 @cindex memory-mapped symbol file
8797 @cindex saving symbol table
8798 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
8799 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
8800 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
8801 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
8802 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
8803 entire symbol table available.
8804
8805 If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
8806 @code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
8807 cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
8808 file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
8809 from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
8810 than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
8811 program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
8812 starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
8813
8814 You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
8815 file has all the symbol information for your program.
8816
8817 The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
8818 @samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
8819 than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
8820 it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
8821 needed.
8822
8823 The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
8824 @value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
8825 symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
8826
8827 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
8828 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
8829 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
8830 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
8831 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
8832 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
8833 @c files.
8834
8835 @kindex core
8836 @kindex core-file
8837 @item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8838 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
8839 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
8840 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
8841 executable file itself for other parts.
8842
8843 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
8844 to be used.
8845
8846 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
8847 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
8848 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
8849 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
8850 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
8851
8852 @kindex add-symbol-file
8853 @cindex dynamic linking
8854 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
8855 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
8856 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}
8857 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
8858 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
8859 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
8860 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
8861 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
8862 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
8863 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
8864 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
8865 @var{address} as an expression.
8866
8867 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
8868 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
8869 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
8870 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
8871 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
8872
8873 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
8874
8875 You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
8876 the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
8877 table information for @var{filename}.
8878
8879 @kindex add-shared-symbol-file
8880 @item add-shared-symbol-file
8881 The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
8882 operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
8883 shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
8884 @code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
8885
8886 @kindex section
8887 @item section
8888 The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
8889 the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
8890 section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
8891 specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
8892 separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
8893 the sections and their addresses.
8894
8895 @kindex info files
8896 @kindex info target
8897 @item info files
8898 @itemx info target
8899 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
8900 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
8901 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
8902 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
8903 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
8904 current ones.
8905
8906 @end table
8907
8908 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
8909 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
8910 name and remembers it that way.
8911
8912 @cindex shared libraries
8913 @value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
8914 libraries.
8915
8916 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
8917 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
8918 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
8919 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
8920 debugging a core file).
8921
8922 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
8923 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
8924
8925 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
8926 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
8927 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
8928
8929 @table @code
8930 @kindex info sharedlibrary
8931 @kindex info share
8932 @item info share
8933 @itemx info sharedlibrary
8934 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
8935
8936 @kindex sharedlibrary
8937 @kindex share
8938 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
8939 @itemx share @var{regex}
8940 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
8941 Unix regular expression.
8942 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
8943 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
8944 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
8945 loaded.
8946 @end table
8947
8948 On HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} detects the loading of a shared library
8949 and automatically reads in symbols from the newly loaded library, up to
8950 a threshold that is initially set but that you can modify if you wish.
8951
8952 Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
8953 loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
8954 @var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
8955 automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
8956
8957 To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
8958
8959 @table @code
8960 @kindex set auto-solib-add
8961 @item set auto-solib-add @var{threshold}
8962 Set the autoloading size threshold, in megabytes. If @var{threshold} is
8963 nonzero, symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded
8964 automatically when the inferior begins execution or when the dynamic
8965 linker informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded, until
8966 the symbol table of the program and libraries exceeds this threshold.
8967 Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
8968 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 megabytes.
8969
8970 @kindex show auto-solib-add
8971 @item show auto-solib-add
8972 Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
8973 @end table
8974
8975 @node Symbol Errors
8976 @section Errors reading symbol files
8977
8978 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
8979 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
8980 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
8981 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
8982 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
8983 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
8984 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
8985 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
8986 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
8987 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
8988 messages}).
8989
8990 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
8991
8992 @table @code
8993 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
8994
8995 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
8996 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
8997 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
8998 in its outer scope blocks.
8999
9000 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
9001 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
9002 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
9003 function.
9004
9005 @item block at @var{address} out of order
9006
9007 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
9008 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
9009 do so.
9010
9011 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
9012 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
9013 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
9014 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9015 messages}.)
9016
9017 @item bad block start address patched
9018
9019 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
9020 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
9021 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
9022
9023 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
9024 starting on the previous source line.
9025
9026 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
9027
9028 @cindex foo
9029 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
9030 larger than the size of the string table.
9031
9032 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
9033 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
9034 with this name.
9035
9036 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
9037
9038 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
9039 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
9040 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
9041
9042 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
9043 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
9044 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
9045 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
9046 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
9047 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
9048
9049 @item stub type has NULL name
9050
9051 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
9052
9053 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
9054 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
9055 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
9056 it.
9057
9058 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
9059
9060 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
9061
9062 @end table
9063
9064 @node Targets
9065 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
9066
9067 @cindex debugging target
9068 @kindex target
9069
9070 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
9071
9072 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
9073 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
9074 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
9075 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
9076 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
9077 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
9078 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
9079 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
9080
9081 @menu
9082 * Active Targets:: Active targets
9083 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
9084 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
9085 * Remote:: Remote debugging
9086 * KOD:: Kernel Object Display
9087
9088 @end menu
9089
9090 @node Active Targets
9091 @section Active targets
9092
9093 @cindex stacking targets
9094 @cindex active targets
9095 @cindex multiple targets
9096
9097 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
9098 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
9099 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
9100 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
9101 a core file.
9102
9103 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
9104 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
9105 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
9106 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
9107 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
9108 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
9109 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
9110 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
9111 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
9112
9113 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
9114 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
9115 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
9116 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
9117 process target is active.
9118
9119 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
9120 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
9121 files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
9122 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
9123 process}).
9124
9125 @node Target Commands
9126 @section Commands for managing targets
9127
9128 @table @code
9129 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
9130 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
9131 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
9132 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
9133 protocol of the target machine.
9134
9135 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
9136 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
9137 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
9138
9139 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
9140 after executing the command.
9141
9142 @kindex help target
9143 @item help target
9144 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
9145 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
9146 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
9147
9148 @item help target @var{name}
9149 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
9150 select it.
9151
9152 @kindex set gnutarget
9153 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
9154 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
9155 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
9156 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
9157 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
9158 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
9159
9160 @quotation
9161 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
9162 you must know the actual BFD name.
9163 @end quotation
9164
9165 @noindent
9166 @xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
9167
9168 @kindex show gnutarget
9169 @item show gnutarget
9170 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
9171 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
9172 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
9173 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
9174 @end table
9175
9176 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
9177 configuration):
9178
9179 @table @code
9180 @kindex target exec
9181 @item target exec @var{program}
9182 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
9183 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
9184
9185 @kindex target core
9186 @item target core @var{filename}
9187 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
9188 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
9189
9190 @kindex target remote
9191 @item target remote @var{dev}
9192 Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
9193 specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
9194 @file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
9195 supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
9196 some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
9197 it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
9198
9199 @kindex target sim
9200 @item target sim
9201 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
9202 In general,
9203 @example
9204 target sim
9205 load
9206 run
9207 @end example
9208 @noindent
9209 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
9210 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
9211 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
9212 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
9213 Processors}.
9214
9215 @end table
9216
9217 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
9218
9219 @table @code
9220
9221 @kindex target nrom
9222 @item target nrom @var{dev}
9223 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
9224
9225 @end table
9226
9227 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
9228 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
9229
9230 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
9231 once you've successfully established a connection.
9232
9233 @table @code
9234
9235 @kindex load @var{filename}
9236 @item load @var{filename}
9237 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
9238 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
9239 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
9240 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
9241 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
9242 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9243
9244 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
9245 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
9246 target is @dots{}}''
9247
9248 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
9249 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
9250 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
9251 specifies a fixed address.
9252 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
9253
9254 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9255 @end table
9256
9257 @node Byte Order
9258 @section Choosing target byte order
9259
9260 @cindex choosing target byte order
9261 @cindex target byte order
9262
9263 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
9264 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
9265 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
9266 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
9267 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
9268 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
9269
9270 @table @code
9271 @kindex set endian big
9272 @item set endian big
9273 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
9274
9275 @kindex set endian little
9276 @item set endian little
9277 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
9278
9279 @kindex set endian auto
9280 @item set endian auto
9281 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
9282 executable.
9283
9284 @item show endian
9285 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
9286
9287 @end table
9288
9289 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
9290 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
9291 target system.
9292
9293 @node Remote
9294 @section Remote debugging
9295 @cindex remote debugging
9296
9297 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
9298 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
9299 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
9300 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
9301 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
9302
9303 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
9304 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
9305 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
9306 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
9307 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
9308 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
9309
9310 Other remote targets may be available in your
9311 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
9312
9313 @menu
9314 * Remote Serial:: @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
9315 @end menu
9316
9317 @node Remote Serial
9318 @subsection The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
9319
9320 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
9321 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
9322 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
9323 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
9324 program, you need:
9325
9326 @enumerate
9327 @item
9328 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
9329 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
9330 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
9331
9332 @item
9333 A C subroutine library to support your program's
9334 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
9335
9336 @item
9337 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
9338 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
9339 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
9340 documentation.
9341 @end enumerate
9342
9343 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
9344 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
9345 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
9346
9347 @table @emph
9348 @item On the host,
9349 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
9350 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
9351 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
9352
9353 @item On the target,
9354 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
9355 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
9356 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
9357
9358 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
9359 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
9360 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
9361 @end table
9362
9363 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
9364 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
9365 @sc{sparc} boards.
9366
9367 @cindex remote serial stub list
9368 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
9369
9370 @table @code
9371
9372 @item i386-stub.c
9373 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
9374 @cindex Intel
9375 @cindex i386
9376 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
9377
9378 @item m68k-stub.c
9379 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
9380 @cindex Motorola 680x0
9381 @cindex m680x0
9382 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
9383
9384 @item sh-stub.c
9385 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
9386 @cindex Hitachi
9387 @cindex SH
9388 For Hitachi SH architectures.
9389
9390 @item sparc-stub.c
9391 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
9392 @cindex Sparc
9393 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
9394
9395 @item sparcl-stub.c
9396 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
9397 @cindex Fujitsu
9398 @cindex SparcLite
9399 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
9400
9401 @end table
9402
9403 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
9404 recently added stubs.
9405
9406 @menu
9407 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
9408 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
9409 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
9410 * Protocol:: Definition of the communication protocol
9411 * Server:: Using the `gdbserver' program
9412 * NetWare:: Using the `gdbserve.nlm' program
9413 @end menu
9414
9415 @node Stub Contents
9416 @subsubsection What the stub can do for you
9417
9418 @cindex remote serial stub
9419 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
9420 subroutines:
9421
9422 @table @code
9423 @item set_debug_traps
9424 @kindex set_debug_traps
9425 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
9426 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
9427 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
9428 beginning of your program.
9429
9430 @item handle_exception
9431 @kindex handle_exception
9432 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
9433 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
9434 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
9435 run when a trap is triggered.
9436
9437 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
9438 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
9439 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
9440 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
9441 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
9442 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
9443 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
9444 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
9445 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
9446 machine.
9447
9448 @item breakpoint
9449 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
9450 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
9451 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
9452 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
9453 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
9454 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
9455 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
9456 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
9457 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
9458 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
9459 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
9460
9461 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
9462 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
9463 start of your debugging session.
9464 @end table
9465
9466 @node Bootstrapping
9467 @subsubsection What you must do for the stub
9468
9469 @cindex remote stub, support routines
9470 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
9471 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
9472 debugging target machine.
9473
9474 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
9475 serial port.
9476
9477 @table @code
9478 @item int getDebugChar()
9479 @kindex getDebugChar
9480 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
9481 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
9482 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
9483
9484 @item void putDebugChar(int)
9485 @kindex putDebugChar
9486 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
9487 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
9488 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
9489 @end table
9490
9491 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
9492 @cindex interrupting remote targets
9493 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
9494 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
9495 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
9496 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
9497 remote system to stop.
9498
9499 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
9500 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
9501 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
9502 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
9503
9504 Other routines you need to supply are:
9505
9506 @table @code
9507 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
9508 @kindex exceptionHandler
9509 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
9510 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
9511 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
9512 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
9513 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
9514 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
9515 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
9516 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
9517 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
9518 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
9519 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
9520 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
9521 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
9522
9523 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
9524 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
9525 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
9526 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
9527 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
9528
9529 @item void flush_i_cache()
9530 @kindex flush_i_cache
9531 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
9532 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
9533 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
9534
9535 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
9536 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
9537 @end table
9538
9539 @noindent
9540 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
9541
9542 @table @code
9543 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
9544 @kindex memset
9545 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
9546 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
9547 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
9548 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
9549 @end table
9550
9551 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
9552 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
9553 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
9554 subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
9555
9556
9557 @node Debug Session
9558 @subsubsection Putting it all together
9559
9560 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
9561 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
9562 steps.
9563
9564 @enumerate
9565 @item
9566 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
9567 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
9568 @display
9569 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
9570 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
9571 @end display
9572
9573 @item
9574 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
9575
9576 @example
9577 set_debug_traps();
9578 breakpoint();
9579 @end example
9580
9581 @item
9582 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
9583 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
9584
9585 @example
9586 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
9587 @end example
9588
9589 @noindent
9590 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
9591 function in your program, that function is called when
9592 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
9593 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
9594 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
9595
9596 @item
9597 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
9598 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
9599
9600 @item
9601 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
9602 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
9603
9604 @item
9605 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
9606 @c document that. FIXME.
9607 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
9608 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
9609
9610 @item
9611 To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
9612 as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
9613 This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
9614 of its pure text.
9615
9616 @item
9617 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
9618 Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
9619 Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
9620 machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
9621 TCP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
9622 to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
9623 device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
9624
9625 @example
9626 target remote /dev/ttyb
9627 @end example
9628
9629 @cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
9630 To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
9631 @code{@var{host}:port}. For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
9632 terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
9633
9634 @example
9635 target remote manyfarms:2828
9636 @end example
9637 @end enumerate
9638
9639 Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
9640 step and continue the remote program.
9641
9642 To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
9643 command.
9644
9645 @cindex interrupting remote programs
9646 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
9647 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
9648 interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
9649 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
9650 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
9651 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
9652
9653 @example
9654 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
9655 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
9656 @end example
9657
9658 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
9659 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
9660 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
9661 goes back to waiting.
9662
9663 @node Protocol
9664 @subsubsection Communication protocol
9665
9666 @cindex debugging stub, example
9667 @cindex remote stub, example
9668 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
9669 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
9670 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
9671 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
9672 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
9673 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
9674 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
9675 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
9676
9677 However, there may be occasions when you need to know something about
9678 the protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your
9679 target machine, you might want your program to do something special if
9680 it recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
9681
9682 In the examples below, @samp{<-} and @samp{->} are used to indicate
9683 transmitted and received data respectfully.
9684
9685 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
9686 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
9687 @cindex remote serial protocol
9688 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
9689 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
9690 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
9691 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
9692
9693 @example
9694 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
9695 @end example
9696 @noindent
9697
9698 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
9699 @noindent
9700 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
9701 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
9702 eight bit unsigned checksum).
9703
9704 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
9705 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
9706
9707 @example
9708 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
9709 @end example
9710
9711 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
9712 @noindent
9713 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
9714 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
9715 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
9716
9717 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
9718 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
9719 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
9720 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
9721 retransmission):
9722
9723 @example
9724 <- @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
9725 -> @code{+}
9726 @end example
9727 @noindent
9728
9729 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
9730 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
9731 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
9732 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
9733
9734 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
9735 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
9736 exceptions).
9737
9738 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
9739 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
9740 HEX with leading zeros suppressed.
9741
9742 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
9743 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
9744 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
9745
9746 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
9747 means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
9748 which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
9749 @samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
9750 where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
9751 characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
9752 value greater than 126 should not be used.
9753
9754 Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
9755 loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
9756 character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
9757
9758 So:
9759 @example
9760 "@code{0* }"
9761 @end example
9762 @noindent
9763 means the same as "0000".
9764
9765 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
9766 error number. That number is not well defined.
9767
9768 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
9769 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
9770 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
9771 on that response.
9772
9773 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
9774 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
9775 optional.
9776
9777 Below is a complete list of all currently defined @var{command}s and
9778 their corresponding response @var{data}:
9779 @page
9780 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .30 .40
9781 @item Packet
9782 @tab Request
9783 @tab Description
9784
9785 @item extended mode
9786 @tab @code{!}
9787 @tab
9788 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
9789 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
9790 debugged.
9791 @item
9792 @tab reply @samp{OK}
9793 @tab
9794 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
9795
9796 @item last signal
9797 @tab @code{?}
9798 @tab
9799 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for step
9800 and continue.
9801 @item
9802 @tab reply
9803 @tab see below
9804
9805
9806 @item reserved
9807 @tab @code{a}
9808 @tab Reserved for future use
9809
9810 @item set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
9811 @tab @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,...}
9812 @tab
9813 @item
9814 @tab
9815 @tab
9816 Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
9817 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
9818 See @file{gdbserver} for more details.
9819 @item
9820 @tab reply @code{OK}
9821 @item
9822 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9823
9824 @item set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
9825 @tab @code{b}@var{baud}
9826 @tab
9827 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}. JTC: @emph{When does the
9828 transport layer state change? When it's received, or after the ACK is
9829 transmitted. In either case, there are problems if the command or the
9830 acknowledgment packet is dropped.} Stan: @emph{If people really wanted
9831 to add something like this, and get it working for the first time, they
9832 ought to modify ser-unix.c to send some kind of out-of-band message to a
9833 specially-setup stub and have the switch happen "in between" packets, so
9834 that from remote protocol's point of view, nothing actually
9835 happened.}
9836
9837 @item set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
9838 @tab @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode}
9839 @tab
9840 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
9841 breakpoint at @var{addr}. @emph{This has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and
9842 @samp{z} packets.}
9843
9844 @item continue
9845 @tab @code{c}@var{addr}
9846 @tab
9847 @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
9848 current address.
9849 @item
9850 @tab reply
9851 @tab see below
9852
9853 @item continue with signal
9854 @tab @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
9855 @tab
9856 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
9857 @code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
9858 @item
9859 @tab reply
9860 @tab see below
9861
9862 @item toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
9863 @tab @code{d}
9864 @tab
9865 toggle debug flag.
9866
9867 @item detach
9868 @tab @code{D}
9869 @tab
9870 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target before
9871 @value{GDBN} disconnects.
9872 @item
9873 @tab reply @emph{no response}
9874 @tab
9875 @value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
9876
9877 @item reserved
9878 @tab @code{e}
9879 @tab Reserved for future use
9880
9881 @item reserved
9882 @tab @code{E}
9883 @tab Reserved for future use
9884
9885 @item reserved
9886 @tab @code{f}
9887 @tab Reserved for future use
9888
9889 @item reserved
9890 @tab @code{F}
9891 @tab Reserved for future use
9892
9893 @item read registers
9894 @tab @code{g}
9895 @tab Read general registers.
9896 @item
9897 @tab reply @var{XX...}
9898 @tab
9899 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
9900 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
9901 each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
9902 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and
9903 @var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
9904 @code{g} packets is specified below.
9905 @item
9906 @tab @code{E}@var{NN}
9907 @tab for an error.
9908
9909 @item write regs
9910 @tab @code{G}@var{XX...}
9911 @tab
9912 See @samp{g} for a description of the @var{XX...} data.
9913 @item
9914 @tab reply @code{OK}
9915 @tab for success
9916 @item
9917 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9918 @tab for an error
9919
9920 @item reserved
9921 @tab @code{h}
9922 @tab Reserved for future use
9923
9924 @item set thread
9925 @tab @code{H}@var{c}@var{t...}
9926 @tab
9927 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
9928 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} = @samp{c} for thread used in step and
9929 continue; @var{t...} can be -1 for all threads. @var{c} = @samp{g} for
9930 thread used in other operations. If zero, pick a thread, any thread.
9931 @item
9932 @tab reply @code{OK}
9933 @tab for success
9934 @item
9935 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9936 @tab for an error
9937
9938 @c FIXME: JTC:
9939 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
9940 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
9941 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
9942 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
9943 @c described. For example:
9944 @c
9945 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
9946 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
9947 @c otherwise returns current registers.
9948 @c
9949 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
9950 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
9951 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
9952
9953 @item cycle step @strong{(draft)}
9954 @tab @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn}
9955 @tab
9956 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
9957 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
9958 step starting at that address.
9959
9960 @item signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
9961 @tab @code{I}
9962 @tab
9963 See @samp{i} and @samp{S} for likely syntax and semantics.
9964
9965 @item reserved
9966 @tab @code{j}
9967 @tab Reserved for future use
9968
9969 @item reserved
9970 @tab @code{J}
9971 @tab Reserved for future use
9972
9973 @item kill request
9974 @tab @code{k}
9975 @tab
9976 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how operate when a specific
9977 thread context has been selected (ie. does 'k' kill only that thread?)}.
9978
9979 @item reserved
9980 @tab @code{l}
9981 @tab Reserved for future use
9982
9983 @item reserved
9984 @tab @code{L}
9985 @tab Reserved for future use
9986
9987 @item read memory
9988 @tab @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9989 @tab
9990 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
9991 Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are assumed
9992 using word alligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
9993 transfer mechanism is needed.}
9994 @item
9995 @tab reply @var{XX...}
9996 @tab
9997 @var{XX...} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
9998 to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that
9999 sized memory transfers are assumed using word alligned accesses. FIXME:
10000 @emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is needed.}
10001 @item
10002 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10003 @tab @var{NN} is errno
10004
10005 @item write mem
10006 @tab @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX...}
10007 @tab
10008 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
10009 @var{XX...} is the data.
10010 @item
10011 @tab reply @code{OK}
10012 @tab for success
10013 @item
10014 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10015 @tab
10016 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
10017 written).
10018
10019 @item reserved
10020 @tab @code{n}
10021 @tab Reserved for future use
10022
10023 @item reserved
10024 @tab @code{N}
10025 @tab Reserved for future use
10026
10027 @item reserved
10028 @tab @code{o}
10029 @tab Reserved for future use
10030
10031 @item reserved
10032 @tab @code{O}
10033 @tab Reserved for future use
10034
10035 @item read reg @strong{(reserved)}
10036 @tab @code{p}@var{n...}
10037 @tab
10038 See write register.
10039 @item
10040 @tab return @var{r....}
10041 @tab The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
10042
10043 @item write reg
10044 @tab @code{P}@var{n...}@code{=}@var{r...}
10045 @tab
10046 Write register @var{n...} with value @var{r...}, which contains two hex
10047 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
10048 @item
10049 @tab reply @code{OK}
10050 @tab for success
10051 @item
10052 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10053 @tab for an error
10054
10055 @item general query
10056 @tab @code{q}@var{query}
10057 @tab
10058 Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries
10059 have a leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a
10060 company prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may
10061 optionally be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs
10062 must ensure that they match the full @var{query} name.
10063 @item
10064 @tab reply @code{XX...}
10065 @tab Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
10066 @item
10067 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10068 @tab error reply
10069 @item
10070 @tab reply @samp{}
10071 @tab Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
10072
10073 @item general set
10074 @tab @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val}
10075 @tab
10076 Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}. See @samp{q} for a discussing of
10077 naming conventions.
10078
10079 @item reset @strong{(deprecated)}
10080 @tab @code{r}
10081 @tab
10082 Reset the entire system.
10083
10084 @item remote restart
10085 @tab @code{R}@var{XX}
10086 @tab
10087 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
10088 This packet is only available in extended mode.
10089 @item
10090 @tab
10091 no reply
10092 @tab
10093 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
10094
10095 @item step
10096 @tab @code{s}@var{addr}
10097 @tab
10098 @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
10099 same address.
10100 @item
10101 @tab reply
10102 @tab see below
10103
10104 @item step with signal
10105 @tab @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
10106 @tab
10107 Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
10108 @item
10109 @tab reply
10110 @tab see below
10111
10112 @item search
10113 @tab @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM}
10114 @tab
10115 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
10116 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4
10117 bytes. @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
10118
10119 @item thread alive
10120 @tab @code{T}@var{XX}
10121 @tab Find out if the thread XX is alive.
10122 @item
10123 @tab reply @code{OK}
10124 @tab thread is still alive
10125 @item
10126 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10127 @tab thread is dead
10128
10129 @item reserved
10130 @tab @code{u}
10131 @tab Reserved for future use
10132
10133 @item reserved
10134 @tab @code{U}
10135 @tab Reserved for future use
10136
10137 @item reserved
10138 @tab @code{v}
10139 @tab Reserved for future use
10140
10141 @item reserved
10142 @tab @code{V}
10143 @tab Reserved for future use
10144
10145 @item reserved
10146 @tab @code{w}
10147 @tab Reserved for future use
10148
10149 @item reserved
10150 @tab @code{W}
10151 @tab Reserved for future use
10152
10153 @item reserved
10154 @tab @code{x}
10155 @tab Reserved for future use
10156
10157 @item write mem (binary)
10158 @tab @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX...}
10159 @tab
10160 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX...} is
10161 binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
10162 escaped using @code{0x7d}.
10163 @item
10164 @tab reply @code{OK}
10165 @tab for success
10166 @item
10167 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10168 @tab for an error
10169
10170 @item reserved
10171 @tab @code{y}
10172 @tab Reserved for future use
10173
10174 @item reserved
10175 @tab @code{Y}
10176 @tab Reserved for future use
10177
10178 @item remove break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
10179 @tab @code{z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
10180 @tab
10181 See @samp{Z}.
10182
10183 @item insert break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
10184 @tab @code{Z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
10185 @tab
10186 @var{t} is type: @samp{0} - software breakpoint, @samp{1} - hardware
10187 breakpoint, @samp{2} - write watchpoint, @samp{3} - read watchpoint,
10188 @samp{4} - access watchpoint; @var{addr} is address; @var{length} is in
10189 bytes. For a software breakpoint, @var{length} specifies the size of
10190 the instruction to be patched. For hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
10191 @var{length} specifies the memory region to be monitored. To avoid
10192 potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should be
10193 implemented in an idempotent way.
10194 @item
10195 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10196 @tab for an error
10197 @item
10198 @tab reply @code{OK}
10199 @tab for success
10200 @item
10201 @tab @samp{}
10202 @tab If not supported.
10203
10204 @item reserved
10205 @tab <other>
10206 @tab Reserved for future use
10207
10208 @end multitable
10209
10210 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
10211 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
10212 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
10213 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
10214 number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
10215 conventions is used.
10216
10217 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
10218
10219 @item @code{S}@var{AA}
10220 @tab @var{AA} is the signal number
10221
10222 @item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
10223 @tab
10224 @var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
10225 (hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
10226 by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
10227 thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = other string not
10228 starting with valid hex digit. @value{GDBN} should ignore this
10229 @var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on to the next. This way we can
10230 extend the protocol.
10231
10232 @item @code{W}@var{AA}
10233 @tab
10234 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
10235 applicable for certains sorts of targets.
10236
10237 @item @code{X}@var{AA}
10238 @tab
10239 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
10240
10241 @item @code{N}@var{AA}@code{;}@var{t...}@code{;}@var{d...}@code{;}@var{b...} @strong{(obsolete)}
10242 @tab
10243 @var{AA} = signal number; @var{t...} = address of symbol "_start";
10244 @var{d...} = base of data section; @var{b...} = base of bss section.
10245 @emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets. The difference between
10246 this reply and the "qOffsets" query is that the 'N' packet may arrive
10247 spontaneously whereas the 'qOffsets' is a query initiated by the host
10248 debugger.}
10249
10250 @item @code{O}@var{XX...}
10251 @tab
10252 @var{XX...} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at any time
10253 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
10254 for 'W', 'T', etc.
10255
10256 @end multitable
10257
10258 The following set and query packets have already been defined.
10259
10260 @multitable @columnfractions .2 .2 .6
10261
10262 @item current thread
10263 @tab @code{q}@code{C}
10264 @tab Return the current thread id.
10265 @item
10266 @tab reply @code{QC}@var{pid}
10267 @tab
10268 Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
10269 @item
10270 @tab reply *
10271 @tab Any other reply implies the old pid.
10272
10273 @item all thread ids
10274 @tab @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
10275 @item
10276 @tab @code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
10277 @tab
10278 Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
10279 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
10280 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
10281 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
10282 be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
10283 sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
10284 @item
10285 @tab
10286 @tab NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
10287 @item
10288 @tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>}
10289 @tab A single thread id
10290 @item
10291 @tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>},@var{<id>...}
10292 @tab a comma-separated list of thread ids
10293 @item
10294 @tab reply @code{l}
10295 @tab (lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
10296 @item
10297 @tab
10298 @tab
10299 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one
10300 or more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. GDB will
10301 respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
10302 @code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
10303 (lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
10304
10305 @item extra thread info
10306 @tab @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id}
10307 @tab
10308 @item
10309 @tab
10310 @tab
10311 Where @var{<id>} is a thread-id in big-endian hex.
10312 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
10313 the target OS. This string may contain anything that the target OS
10314 thinks is interesting for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread.
10315 The string is displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display.
10316 Some examples of possible thread extra info strings are "Runnable", or
10317 "Blocked on Mutex".
10318 @item
10319 @tab reply @var{XX...}
10320 @tab
10321 Where @var{XX...} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising the
10322 printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
10323 attributes.
10324
10325 @item query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
10326 @tab @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread}
10327 @tab
10328 @item
10329 @tab
10330 @tab
10331 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
10332 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
10333 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
10334 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
10335 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
10336 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
10337 @item
10338 @tab
10339 @tab NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
10340 query (see above).
10341 @item
10342 @tab reply @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread...}
10343 @tab
10344 @item
10345 @tab
10346 @tab
10347 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
10348 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
10349 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
10350 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread...} is
10351 a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
10352 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
10353
10354 @item compute CRC of memory block
10355 @tab @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
10356 @tab
10357 @item
10358 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10359 @tab An error (such as memory fault)
10360 @item
10361 @tab reply @code{C}@var{CRC32}
10362 @tab A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
10363
10364 @item query sect offs
10365 @tab @code{q}@code{Offsets}
10366 @tab
10367 Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
10368 image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
10369 response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
10370 offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
10371 @item
10372 @tab reply @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
10373
10374 @item thread info request
10375 @tab @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid}
10376 @tab
10377 @item
10378 @tab
10379 @tab
10380 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
10381 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
10382 @item
10383 @tab reply *
10384 @tab
10385 See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
10386
10387 @item remote command
10388 @tab @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{COMMAND}
10389 @tab
10390 @item
10391 @tab
10392 @tab
10393 @var{COMMAND} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
10394 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
10395 Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
10396 number of intermediate @code{O}@var{OUTPUT} console output
10397 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
10398 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
10399 @item
10400 @tab reply @code{OK}
10401 @tab
10402 A command response with no output.
10403 @item
10404 @tab reply @var{OUTPUT}
10405 @tab
10406 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
10407 @item
10408 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10409 @tab
10410 Indicate a badly formed request.
10411
10412 @item
10413 @tab reply @samp{}
10414 @tab
10415 When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
10416
10417 @item symbol lookup
10418 @tab @code{qSymbol::}
10419 @tab
10420 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
10421 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
10422 @item
10423 @tab
10424 @tab
10425 @item
10426 @tab reply @code{OK}
10427 @tab
10428 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
10429 @item
10430 @tab reply @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
10431 @tab
10432 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
10433 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
10434 @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
10435 message, described below.
10436
10437 @item symbol value
10438 @tab @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
10439 @tab
10440 Set the value of SYM_NAME to SYM_VALUE.
10441 @item
10442 @tab
10443 @tab
10444 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value
10445 the target has previously requested.
10446 @item
10447 @tab
10448 @tab
10449 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}.
10450 If @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this
10451 field will be empty.
10452 @item
10453 @tab reply @code{OK}
10454 @tab
10455 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
10456 @item
10457 @tab reply @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
10458 @tab
10459 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
10460 @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols (if available),
10461 until the target ceases to request them.
10462
10463 @end multitable
10464
10465 The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
10466 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as sixty-four
10467 bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?) to fill the
10468 space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target byte order.
10469 The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered most-significant -
10470 least-significant.
10471
10472 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
10473
10474 @item MIPS32
10475 @tab
10476 All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
10477 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
10478 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
10479
10480 @item MIPS64
10481 @tab
10482 All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
10483 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
10484 as @code{MIPS32}.
10485
10486 @end multitable
10487
10488 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
10489 does not get any direct output:
10490
10491 @example
10492 <- @code{R00}
10493 -> @code{+}
10494 @emph{target restarts}
10495 <- @code{?}
10496 -> @code{+}
10497 -> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
10498 <- @code{+}
10499 @end example
10500
10501 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
10502
10503 @example
10504 <- @code{G1445...}
10505 -> @code{+}
10506 <- @code{s}
10507 -> @code{+}
10508 @emph{time passes}
10509 -> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
10510 <- @code{+}
10511 <- @code{g}
10512 -> @code{+}
10513 -> @code{1455...}
10514 <- @code{+}
10515 @end example
10516
10517 @node Server
10518 @subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserver} program
10519
10520 @kindex gdbserver
10521 @cindex remote connection without stubs
10522 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
10523 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10524 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
10525
10526 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
10527 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
10528 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
10529 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
10530 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
10531 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
10532 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
10533 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
10534 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
10535 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
10536 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
10537 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
10538 choice for debugging.
10539
10540 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
10541 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
10542 protocol.
10543
10544 @table @emph
10545 @item On the target machine,
10546 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10547 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
10548 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
10549 system does all the symbol handling.
10550
10551 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
10552 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The
10553 syntax is:
10554
10555 @smallexample
10556 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10557 @end smallexample
10558
10559 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
10560 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
10561 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
10562 @file{/dev/com1}:
10563
10564 @smallexample
10565 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
10566 @end smallexample
10567
10568 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
10569 with it.
10570
10571 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
10572
10573 @smallexample
10574 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
10575 @end smallexample
10576
10577 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
10578 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
10579 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
10580 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
10581 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
10582 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
10583 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
10584 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
10585 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
10586 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
10587 @code{target remote} command.
10588
10589 @item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10590 you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10591 symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10592 using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10593 (You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10594 running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
10595 remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
10596 is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
10597 @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
10598 @code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
10599
10600 @smallexample
10601 (@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10602 @end smallexample
10603
10604 @noindent
10605 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
10606
10607 @smallexample
10608 (@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
10609 @end smallexample
10610
10611 @noindent
10612 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
10613 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
10614 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
10615 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
10616 @samp{Connection refused}.
10617 @end table
10618
10619 @node NetWare
10620 @subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
10621
10622 @kindex gdbserve.nlm
10623 @code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
10624 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10625 @code{target remote}.
10626
10627 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
10628 using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
10629
10630 @table @emph
10631 @item On the target machine,
10632 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10633 @code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
10634 can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
10635 host system does all the symbol handling.
10636
10637 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
10638 @value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
10639 program. The syntax is:
10640
10641 @smallexample
10642 load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
10643 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10644 @end smallexample
10645
10646 @var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
10647 the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
10648 to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
10649
10650 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
10651 communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
10652 using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
10653
10654 @smallexample
10655 load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
10656 @end smallexample
10657
10658 @item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10659 you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10660 symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10661 using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10662 (You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10663 running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
10664 remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
10665 argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
10666 @file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
10667
10668 @smallexample
10669 (@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10670 @end smallexample
10671
10672 @noindent
10673 communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
10674 @end table
10675
10676 @node KOD
10677 @section Kernel Object Display
10678
10679 @cindex kernel object display
10680 @cindex kernel object
10681 @cindex KOD
10682
10683 Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
10684 @value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
10685 and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
10686 mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
10687 displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
10688
10689 Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
10690 @value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
10691
10692 @example
10693 (@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
10694 @end example
10695
10696 If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
10697 about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
10698 which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
10699 after the operating system:
10700
10701 @example
10702 (@value{GDBP}) info cisco
10703 List of Cisco Kernel Objects
10704 Object Description
10705 any Any and all objects
10706 @end example
10707
10708 Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
10709 by the kernel.
10710
10711 There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
10712 is supported other than to try it.
10713
10714
10715 @node Configurations
10716 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
10717
10718 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
10719 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
10720 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
10721
10722 There are three major categories of configurations: native
10723 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
10724 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
10725 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
10726 are quite different from each other.
10727
10728 @menu
10729 * Native::
10730 * Embedded OS::
10731 * Embedded Processors::
10732 * Architectures::
10733 @end menu
10734
10735 @node Native
10736 @section Native
10737
10738 This section describes details specific to particular native
10739 configurations.
10740
10741 @menu
10742 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
10743 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
10744 @end menu
10745
10746 @node HP-UX
10747 @subsection HP-UX
10748
10749 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10750 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10751 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
10752
10753 @node SVR4 Process Information
10754 @subsection SVR4 process information
10755
10756 @kindex /proc
10757 @cindex process image
10758
10759 Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
10760 used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
10761 subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
10762 this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
10763 several kinds of information about the process running your program.
10764 @code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
10765 @code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
10766 and Unixware, but not HP-UX or Linux, for example.
10767
10768 @table @code
10769 @kindex info proc
10770 @item info proc
10771 Summarize available information about the process.
10772
10773 @kindex info proc mappings
10774 @item info proc mappings
10775 Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
10776 on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
10777
10778 @kindex info proc times
10779 @item info proc times
10780 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
10781 its children.
10782
10783 @kindex info proc id
10784 @item info proc id
10785 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
10786 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
10787
10788 @kindex info proc status
10789 @item info proc status
10790 General information on the state of the process. If the process is
10791 stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
10792 received.
10793
10794 @item info proc all
10795 Show all the above information about the process.
10796 @end table
10797
10798 @node Embedded OS
10799 @section Embedded Operating Systems
10800
10801 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
10802 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
10803 architectures.
10804
10805 @menu
10806 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
10807 @end menu
10808
10809 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
10810 various real-time operating systems.
10811
10812 @node VxWorks
10813 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
10814
10815 @cindex VxWorks
10816
10817 @table @code
10818
10819 @kindex target vxworks
10820 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
10821 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
10822 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
10823
10824 @end table
10825
10826 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
10827 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
10828
10829 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
10830 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
10831 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
10832 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
10833 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
10834 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
10835 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
10836
10837 @table @code
10838 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
10839 @kindex vxworks-timeout
10840 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
10841 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
10842 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
10843 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
10844 of a thin network line.
10845 @end table
10846
10847 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
10848 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
10849 procedures.
10850
10851 @kindex INCLUDE_RDB
10852 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
10853 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
10854 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
10855 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
10856 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
10857 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
10858 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
10859 manual.
10860 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
10861
10862 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
10863 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
10864 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
10865 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
10866
10867 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
10868
10869 @example
10870 (vxgdb)
10871 @end example
10872
10873 @menu
10874 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
10875 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
10876 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
10877 @end menu
10878
10879 @node VxWorks Connection
10880 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
10881
10882 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
10883 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
10884
10885 @example
10886 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
10887 @end example
10888
10889 @need 750
10890 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
10891
10892 @smallexample
10893 Attaching remote machine across net...
10894 Connected to tt.
10895 @end smallexample
10896
10897 @need 1000
10898 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
10899 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
10900 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
10901 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
10902 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
10903
10904 @example
10905 prog.o: No such file or directory.
10906 @end example
10907
10908 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
10909 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
10910 command again.
10911
10912 @node VxWorks Download
10913 @subsubsection VxWorks download
10914
10915 @cindex download to VxWorks
10916 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
10917 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
10918 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
10919 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
10920 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
10921 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
10922 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
10923 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
10924 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
10925 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
10926 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
10927 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
10928 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
10929 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
10930 program, type this on VxWorks:
10931
10932 @example
10933 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
10934 @end example
10935
10936 @noindent
10937 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
10938
10939 @example
10940 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
10941 (vxgdb) load prog.o
10942 @end example
10943
10944 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
10945
10946 @smallexample
10947 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
10948 @end smallexample
10949
10950 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
10951 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
10952 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
10953 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
10954 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
10955 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
10956 table.)
10957
10958 @node VxWorks Attach
10959 @subsubsection Running tasks
10960
10961 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
10962 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
10963 follows:
10964
10965 @example
10966 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
10967 @end example
10968
10969 @noindent
10970 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
10971 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
10972 the time of attachment.
10973
10974 @node Embedded Processors
10975 @section Embedded Processors
10976
10977 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
10978 configurations.
10979
10980 @menu
10981 * A29K Embedded:: AMD A29K Embedded
10982 * ARM:: ARM
10983 * H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
10984 * H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
10985 * i960:: Intel i960
10986 * M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
10987 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
10988 * M88K:: Motorola M88K
10989 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
10990 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
10991 * PowerPC: PowerPC
10992 * SH:: Hitachi SH
10993 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
10994 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
10995 * ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
10996 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
10997 @end menu
10998
10999 @node A29K Embedded
11000 @subsection AMD A29K Embedded
11001
11002 @menu
11003 * A29K UDI::
11004 * A29K EB29K::
11005 * Comms (EB29K):: Communications setup
11006 * gdb-EB29K:: EB29K cross-debugging
11007 * Remote Log:: Remote log
11008 @end menu
11009
11010 @table @code
11011
11012 @kindex target adapt
11013 @item target adapt @var{dev}
11014 Adapt monitor for A29K.
11015
11016 @kindex target amd-eb
11017 @item target amd-eb @var{dev} @var{speed} @var{PROG}
11018 @cindex AMD EB29K
11019 Remote PC-resident AMD EB29K board, attached over serial lines.
11020 @var{dev} is the serial device, as for @code{target remote};
11021 @var{speed} allows you to specify the linespeed; and @var{PROG} is the
11022 name of the program to be debugged, as it appears to DOS on the PC.
11023 @xref{A29K EB29K, ,EBMON protocol for AMD29K}.
11024
11025 @end table
11026
11027 @node A29K UDI
11028 @subsubsection A29K UDI
11029
11030 @cindex UDI
11031 @cindex AMD29K via UDI
11032
11033 @value{GDBN} supports AMD's UDI (``Universal Debugger Interface'')
11034 protocol for debugging the a29k processor family. To use this
11035 configuration with AMD targets running the MiniMON monitor, you need the
11036 program @code{MONTIP}, available from AMD at no charge. You can also
11037 use @value{GDBN} with the UDI-conformant a29k simulator program
11038 @code{ISSTIP}, also available from AMD.
11039
11040 @table @code
11041 @item target udi @var{keyword}
11042 @kindex udi
11043 Select the UDI interface to a remote a29k board or simulator, where
11044 @var{keyword} is an entry in the AMD configuration file @file{udi_soc}.
11045 This file contains keyword entries which specify parameters used to
11046 connect to a29k targets. If the @file{udi_soc} file is not in your
11047 working directory, you must set the environment variable @samp{UDICONF}
11048 to its pathname.
11049 @end table
11050
11051 @node A29K EB29K
11052 @subsubsection EBMON protocol for AMD29K
11053
11054 @cindex EB29K board
11055 @cindex running 29K programs
11056
11057 AMD distributes a 29K development board meant to fit in a PC, together
11058 with a DOS-hosted monitor program called @code{EBMON}. As a shorthand
11059 term, this development system is called the ``EB29K''. To use
11060 @value{GDBN} from a Unix system to run programs on the EB29K board, you
11061 must first connect a serial cable between the PC (which hosts the EB29K
11062 board) and a serial port on the Unix system. In the following, we
11063 assume you've hooked the cable between the PC's @file{COM1} port and
11064 @file{/dev/ttya} on the Unix system.
11065
11066 @node Comms (EB29K)
11067 @subsubsection Communications setup
11068
11069 The next step is to set up the PC's port, by doing something like this
11070 in DOS on the PC:
11071
11072 @example
11073 C:\> MODE com1:9600,n,8,1,none
11074 @end example
11075
11076 @noindent
11077 This example---run on an MS DOS 4.0 system---sets the PC port to 9600
11078 bps, no parity, eight data bits, one stop bit, and no ``retry'' action;
11079 you must match the communications parameters when establishing the Unix
11080 end of the connection as well.
11081 @c FIXME: Who knows what this "no retry action" crud from the DOS manual may
11082 @c mean? It's optional; leave it out? ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
11083 @c
11084 @c It's optional, but it's unwise to omit it: who knows what is the
11085 @c default value set when the DOS machines boots? "No retry" means that
11086 @c the DOS serial device driver won't retry the operation if it fails;
11087 @c I understand that this is needed because the GDB serial protocol
11088 @c handles any errors and retransmissions itself. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3sep99
11089
11090 To give control of the PC to the Unix side of the serial line, type
11091 the following at the DOS console:
11092
11093 @example
11094 C:\> CTTY com1
11095 @end example
11096
11097 @noindent
11098 (Later, if you wish to return control to the DOS console, you can use
11099 the command @code{CTTY con}---but you must send it over the device that
11100 had control, in our example over the @file{COM1} serial line.)
11101
11102 From the Unix host, use a communications program such as @code{tip} or
11103 @code{cu} to communicate with the PC; for example,
11104
11105 @example
11106 cu -s 9600 -l /dev/ttya
11107 @end example
11108
11109 @noindent
11110 The @code{cu} options shown specify, respectively, the linespeed and the
11111 serial port to use. If you use @code{tip} instead, your command line
11112 may look something like the following:
11113
11114 @example
11115 tip -9600 /dev/ttya
11116 @end example
11117
11118 @noindent
11119 Your system may require a different name where we show
11120 @file{/dev/ttya} as the argument to @code{tip}. The communications
11121 parameters, including which port to use, are associated with the
11122 @code{tip} argument in the ``remote'' descriptions file---normally the
11123 system table @file{/etc/remote}.
11124 @c FIXME: What if anything needs doing to match the "n,8,1,none" part of
11125 @c the DOS side's comms setup? cu can support -o (odd
11126 @c parity), -e (even parity)---apparently no settings for no parity or
11127 @c for character size. Taken from stty maybe...? John points out tip
11128 @c can set these as internal variables, eg ~s parity=none; man stty
11129 @c suggests that it *might* work to stty these options with stdin or
11130 @c stdout redirected... ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
11131 @c
11132 @c There's nothing to be done for the "none" part of the DOS MODE
11133 @c command. The rest of the parameters should be matched by the
11134 @c baudrate, bits, and parity used by the Unix side. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3Sep99
11135
11136 @kindex EBMON
11137 Using the @code{tip} or @code{cu} connection, change the DOS working
11138 directory to the directory containing a copy of your 29K program, then
11139 start the PC program @code{EBMON} (an EB29K control program supplied
11140 with your board by AMD). You should see an initial display from
11141 @code{EBMON} similar to the one that follows, ending with the
11142 @code{EBMON} prompt @samp{#}---
11143
11144 @example
11145 C:\> G:
11146
11147 G:\> CD \usr\joe\work29k
11148
11149 G:\USR\JOE\WORK29K> EBMON
11150 Am29000 PC Coprocessor Board Monitor, version 3.0-18
11151 Copyright 1990 Advanced Micro Devices, Inc.
11152 Written by Gibbons and Associates, Inc.
11153
11154 Enter '?' or 'H' for help
11155
11156 PC Coprocessor Type = EB29K
11157 I/O Base = 0x208
11158 Memory Base = 0xd0000
11159
11160 Data Memory Size = 2048KB
11161 Available I-RAM Range = 0x8000 to 0x1fffff
11162 Available D-RAM Range = 0x80002000 to 0x801fffff
11163
11164 PageSize = 0x400
11165 Register Stack Size = 0x800
11166 Memory Stack Size = 0x1800
11167
11168 CPU PRL = 0x3
11169 Am29027 Available = No
11170 Byte Write Available = Yes
11171
11172 # ~.
11173 @end example
11174
11175 Then exit the @code{cu} or @code{tip} program (done in the example by
11176 typing @code{~.} at the @code{EBMON} prompt). @code{EBMON} keeps
11177 running, ready for @value{GDBN} to take over.
11178
11179 For this example, we've assumed what is probably the most convenient
11180 way to make sure the same 29K program is on both the PC and the Unix
11181 system: a PC/NFS connection that establishes ``drive @file{G:}'' on the
11182 PC as a file system on the Unix host. If you do not have PC/NFS or
11183 something similar connecting the two systems, you must arrange some
11184 other way---perhaps floppy-disk transfer---of getting the 29K program
11185 from the Unix system to the PC; @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} download it over the
11186 serial line.
11187
11188 @node gdb-EB29K
11189 @subsubsection EB29K cross-debugging
11190
11191 Finally, @code{cd} to the directory containing an image of your 29K
11192 program on the Unix system, and start @value{GDBN}---specifying as argument the
11193 name of your 29K program:
11194
11195 @example
11196 cd /usr/joe/work29k
11197 @value{GDBP} myfoo
11198 @end example
11199
11200 @need 500
11201 Now you can use the @code{target} command:
11202
11203 @example
11204 target amd-eb /dev/ttya 9600 MYFOO
11205 @c FIXME: test above 'target amd-eb' as spelled, with caps! caps are meant to
11206 @c emphasize that this is the name as seen by DOS (since I think DOS is
11207 @c single-minded about case of letters). ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
11208 @end example
11209
11210 @noindent
11211 In this example, we've assumed your program is in a file called
11212 @file{myfoo}. Note that the filename given as the last argument to
11213 @code{target amd-eb} should be the name of the program as it appears to DOS.
11214 In our example this is simply @code{MYFOO}, but in general it can include
11215 a DOS path, and depending on your transfer mechanism may not resemble
11216 the name on the Unix side.
11217
11218 At this point, you can set any breakpoints you wish; when you are ready
11219 to see your program run on the 29K board, use the @value{GDBN} command
11220 @code{run}.
11221
11222 To stop debugging the remote program, use the @value{GDBN} @code{detach}
11223 command.
11224
11225 To return control of the PC to its console, use @code{tip} or @code{cu}
11226 once again, after your @value{GDBN} session has concluded, to attach to
11227 @code{EBMON}. You can then type the command @code{q} to shut down
11228 @code{EBMON}, returning control to the DOS command-line interpreter.
11229 Type @kbd{CTTY con} to return command input to the main DOS console,
11230 and type @kbd{~.} to leave @code{tip} or @code{cu}.
11231
11232 @node Remote Log
11233 @subsubsection Remote log
11234 @cindex @file{eb.log}, a log file for EB29K
11235 @cindex log file for EB29K
11236
11237 The @code{target amd-eb} command creates a file @file{eb.log} in the
11238 current working directory, to help debug problems with the connection.
11239 @file{eb.log} records all the output from @code{EBMON}, including echoes
11240 of the commands sent to it. Running @samp{tail -f} on this file in
11241 another window often helps to understand trouble with @code{EBMON}, or
11242 unexpected events on the PC side of the connection.
11243
11244 @node ARM
11245 @subsection ARM
11246
11247 @table @code
11248
11249 @kindex target rdi
11250 @item target rdi @var{dev}
11251 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
11252 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
11253 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
11254
11255 @kindex target rdp
11256 @item target rdp @var{dev}
11257 ARM Demon monitor.
11258
11259 @end table
11260
11261 @node H8/300
11262 @subsection Hitachi H8/300
11263
11264 @table @code
11265
11266 @kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
11267 @item target hms @var{dev}
11268 A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
11269 Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
11270 line and the communications speed used.
11271
11272 @kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
11273 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
11274 E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
11275
11276 @kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
11277 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
11278 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
11279 @itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
11280 Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11281
11282 @end table
11283
11284 @cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
11285 @cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
11286 @cindex download to Hitachi SH
11287 @cindex Hitachi SH download
11288 When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
11289 board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
11290 board and also opens it as the current executable target for
11291 @value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
11292
11293 @value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
11294 Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
11295
11296 @enumerate
11297 @item
11298 that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
11299 for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
11300 emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
11301 the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
11302 H8/300, or H8/500.)
11303
11304 @item
11305 what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
11306 serial device available on your host is the default).
11307
11308 @item
11309 what speed to use over the serial device.
11310 @end enumerate
11311
11312 @menu
11313 * Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
11314 * Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
11315 * Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
11316 @end menu
11317
11318 @node Hitachi Boards
11319 @subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
11320
11321 @c only for Unix hosts
11322 @kindex device
11323 @cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
11324 Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
11325 need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
11326 first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
11327 hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
11328
11329 @kindex speed
11330 @cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
11331 @code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
11332 speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
11333 hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
11334 the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
11335 @w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
11336
11337 The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
11338 use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
11339 use a DOS host,
11340 @value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
11341 called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
11342 through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
11343 to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
11344
11345 The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
11346 program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
11347 sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
11348 the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
11349
11350 First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
11351 board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
11352 port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
11353 When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
11354 debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
11355 for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
11356 @code{COM2}.
11357
11358 @example
11359 C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
11360 C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
11361
11362 Resident portion of MODE loaded
11363
11364 COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
11365
11366 @end example
11367
11368 @quotation
11369 @emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
11370 @code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
11371 disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
11372 your development board.
11373 @end quotation
11374
11375 @kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
11376 Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
11377 connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
11378 the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
11379 you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
11380 commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
11381 cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
11382 download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
11383 the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
11384 (If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
11385 executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
11386 @code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
11387 itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
11388
11389 @smallexample
11390 (eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
11391 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
11392 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
11393 the conditions.
11394 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
11395 for details.
11396 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
11397 (@value{GDBP}) target hms
11398 Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
11399 (@value{GDBP}) load t.x
11400 .text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
11401 .data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
11402 .stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
11403 @end smallexample
11404
11405 At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
11406 you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
11407 sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
11408 @code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
11409 resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
11410 @code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
11411
11412 Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
11413 available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
11414 you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
11415
11416 Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
11417 @itemize @bullet
11418 @item
11419 to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
11420 no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
11421
11422 @item
11423 to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
11424 normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
11425 to detect program completion.
11426 @end itemize
11427
11428 In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
11429 development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
11430
11431 @node Hitachi ICE
11432 @subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
11433
11434 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
11435 You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
11436 Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
11437 e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
11438
11439 @table @code
11440 @item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
11441 Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
11442 @var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
11443 @samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
11444 (for example, @samp{9600}).
11445
11446 @item target e7000 @var{hostname}
11447 If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
11448 specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
11449 @end table
11450
11451 @node Hitachi Special
11452 @subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
11453
11454 Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
11455
11456 @table @code
11457
11458 @kindex set machine
11459 @kindex show machine
11460 @item set machine h8300
11461 @itemx set machine h8300h
11462 Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
11463 architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
11464 to check which variant is currently in effect.
11465
11466 @end table
11467
11468 @node H8/500
11469 @subsection H8/500
11470
11471 @table @code
11472
11473 @kindex set memory @var{mod}
11474 @cindex memory models, H8/500
11475 @item set memory @var{mod}
11476 @itemx show memory
11477 Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
11478 @samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
11479 memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
11480 @code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
11481
11482 @end table
11483
11484 @node i960
11485 @subsection Intel i960
11486
11487 @table @code
11488
11489 @kindex target mon960
11490 @item target mon960 @var{dev}
11491 MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
11492
11493 @kindex target nindy
11494 @item target nindy @var{devicename}
11495 An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
11496 the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
11497 @file{/dev/ttya}.
11498
11499 @end table
11500
11501 @cindex Nindy
11502 @cindex i960
11503 @dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems. When
11504 @value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
11505 tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
11506
11507 @itemize @bullet
11508 @item
11509 Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
11510 Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
11511
11512 @item
11513 By responding to a prompt on startup;
11514
11515 @item
11516 By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
11517 session. @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
11518
11519 @end itemize
11520
11521 @cindex download to Nindy-960
11522 With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
11523 downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
11524 @value{GDBN}.
11525
11526 @menu
11527 * Nindy Startup:: Startup with Nindy
11528 * Nindy Options:: Options for Nindy
11529 * Nindy Reset:: Nindy reset command
11530 @end menu
11531
11532 @node Nindy Startup
11533 @subsubsection Startup with Nindy
11534
11535 If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
11536 options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
11537 reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
11538
11539 @example
11540 Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
11541 @end example
11542
11543 @noindent
11544 Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
11545 identifies the serial port you want to use. You can, if you choose,
11546 simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
11547 with an empty line. If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
11548 use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
11549
11550 @node Nindy Options
11551 @subsubsection Options for Nindy
11552
11553 These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
11554 Nindy-960 board attached:
11555
11556 @table @code
11557 @item -r @var{port}
11558 Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
11559 to the target system. This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
11560 configured for the Intel 960 target architecture. You may specify
11561 @var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
11562 device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
11563 suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
11564
11565 @item -O
11566 (An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.) Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
11567 the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
11568 This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
11569 target architecture.
11570
11571 @quotation
11572 @emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
11573 connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
11574 fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch. @value{GDBN} repeatedly
11575 attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds. You can abort
11576 this process with an interrupt.
11577 @end quotation
11578
11579 @item -brk
11580 Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
11581 system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
11582
11583 @quotation
11584 @emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
11585 requires; it only works with a few boards.
11586 @end quotation
11587 @end table
11588
11589 The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
11590 port.
11591
11592 @c @group
11593 @node Nindy Reset
11594 @subsubsection Nindy reset command
11595
11596 @table @code
11597 @item reset
11598 @kindex reset
11599 For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
11600 system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
11601 circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
11602 a break is detected.
11603 @end table
11604 @c @end group
11605
11606 @node M32R/D
11607 @subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
11608
11609 @table @code
11610
11611 @kindex target m32r
11612 @item target m32r @var{dev}
11613 Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
11614
11615 @end table
11616
11617 @node M68K
11618 @subsection M68k
11619
11620 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
11621 target command for the following ROM monitors.
11622
11623 @table @code
11624
11625 @kindex target abug
11626 @item target abug @var{dev}
11627 ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
11628
11629 @kindex target cpu32bug
11630 @item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
11631 CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11632
11633 @kindex target dbug
11634 @item target dbug @var{dev}
11635 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
11636
11637 @kindex target est
11638 @item target est @var{dev}
11639 EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11640
11641 @kindex target rom68k
11642 @item target rom68k @var{dev}
11643 ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
11644
11645 @end table
11646
11647 If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
11648 instead have only a single special target command:
11649
11650 @table @code
11651
11652 @kindex target es1800
11653 @item target es1800 @var{dev}
11654 ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
11655
11656 @end table
11657
11658 [context?]
11659
11660 @table @code
11661
11662 @kindex target rombug
11663 @item target rombug @var{dev}
11664 ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
11665
11666 @end table
11667
11668 @node M88K
11669 @subsection M88K
11670
11671 @table @code
11672
11673 @kindex target bug
11674 @item target bug @var{dev}
11675 BUG monitor, running on a MVME187 (m88k) board.
11676
11677 @end table
11678
11679 @node MIPS Embedded
11680 @subsection MIPS Embedded
11681
11682 @cindex MIPS boards
11683 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
11684 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
11685 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
11686
11687 @need 1000
11688 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
11689
11690 @table @code
11691 @item target mips @var{port}
11692 @kindex target mips @var{port}
11693 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
11694 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
11695 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
11696 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
11697 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
11698 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
11699
11700 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
11701 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
11702 debugger:
11703
11704 @example
11705 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
11706 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
11707 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
11708 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
11709 (@value{GDBP}) run
11710 @end example
11711
11712 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
11713 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
11714 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
11715 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
11716 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
11717
11718 @item target pmon @var{port}
11719 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
11720 PMON ROM monitor.
11721
11722 @item target ddb @var{port}
11723 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
11724 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
11725
11726 @item target lsi @var{port}
11727 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
11728 LSI variant of PMON.
11729
11730 @kindex target r3900
11731 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
11732 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
11733
11734 @kindex target array
11735 @item target array @var{dev}
11736 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
11737
11738 @end table
11739
11740
11741 @noindent
11742 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
11743
11744 @table @code
11745 @item set processor @var{args}
11746 @itemx show processor
11747 @kindex set processor @var{args}
11748 @kindex show processor
11749 Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
11750 processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
11751 For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
11752 to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
11753 Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
11754 is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
11755 @value{GDBN} is using.
11756
11757 @item set mipsfpu double
11758 @itemx set mipsfpu single
11759 @itemx set mipsfpu none
11760 @itemx show mipsfpu
11761 @kindex set mipsfpu
11762 @kindex show mipsfpu
11763 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
11764 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
11765 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
11766 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
11767 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
11768 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
11769 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
11770 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
11771 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
11772 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
11773 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
11774 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
11775 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
11776
11777 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
11778 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
11779 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
11780
11781 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
11782 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
11783
11784 @item set remotedebug @var{n}
11785 @itemx show remotedebug
11786 @kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11787 @kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11788 @cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
11789 @cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
11790 @c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
11791 @c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
11792 You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
11793 by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
11794 @samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
11795 to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
11796 at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
11797
11798 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
11799 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
11800 @itemx show timeout
11801 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
11802 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
11803 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
11804 @kindex set timeout
11805 @kindex show timeout
11806 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
11807 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
11808 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
11809 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
11810 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
11811 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
11812 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
11813 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
11814 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
11815 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
11816
11817 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
11818 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
11819 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
11820 to run before stopping.
11821 @end table
11822
11823 @node PowerPC
11824 @subsection PowerPC
11825
11826 @table @code
11827
11828 @kindex target dink32
11829 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
11830 DINK32 ROM monitor.
11831
11832 @kindex target ppcbug
11833 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
11834 @kindex target ppcbug1
11835 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
11836 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
11837
11838 @kindex target sds
11839 @item target sds @var{dev}
11840 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
11841
11842 @end table
11843
11844 @node PA
11845 @subsection HP PA Embedded
11846
11847 @table @code
11848
11849 @kindex target op50n
11850 @item target op50n @var{dev}
11851 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
11852
11853 @kindex target w89k
11854 @item target w89k @var{dev}
11855 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
11856
11857 @end table
11858
11859 @node SH
11860 @subsection Hitachi SH
11861
11862 @table @code
11863
11864 @kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
11865 @item target hms @var{dev}
11866 A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
11867 commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
11868 the communications speed used.
11869
11870 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
11871 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
11872 E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
11873
11874 @kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
11875 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
11876 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
11877 @item target sh3e @var{dev}
11878 Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11879
11880 @end table
11881
11882 @node Sparclet
11883 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
11884
11885 @cindex Sparclet
11886
11887 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
11888 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
11889 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11890 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
11891 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
11892
11893 @table @code
11894 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
11895 @kindex remotetimeout
11896 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
11897 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11898 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
11899 @end table
11900
11901 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
11902 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
11903 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
11904 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
11905 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
11906
11907 @example
11908 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
11909 @end example
11910
11911 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
11912
11913 @example
11914 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
11915 @end example
11916
11917 @cindex running, on Sparclet
11918 Once you have set
11919 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
11920 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
11921 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
11922
11923 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
11924
11925 @example
11926 (gdbslet)
11927 @end example
11928
11929 @menu
11930 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
11931 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
11932 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
11933 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
11934 @end menu
11935
11936 @node Sparclet File
11937 @subsubsection Setting file to debug
11938
11939 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
11940
11941 @example
11942 (gdbslet) file prog
11943 @end example
11944
11945 @need 1000
11946 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
11947 @value{GDBN} locates
11948 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
11949 path.
11950 If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
11951 files will be searched as well.
11952 @value{GDBN} locates
11953 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
11954 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
11955 If it fails
11956 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
11957
11958 @example
11959 prog: No such file or directory.
11960 @end example
11961
11962 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
11963 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
11964 @code{target} command again.
11965
11966 @node Sparclet Connection
11967 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
11968
11969 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
11970 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
11971
11972 @example
11973 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
11974 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
11975 main () at ../prog.c:3
11976 @end example
11977
11978 @need 750
11979 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
11980
11981 @example
11982 Connected to ttya.
11983 @end example
11984
11985 @node Sparclet Download
11986 @subsubsection Sparclet download
11987
11988 @cindex download to Sparclet
11989 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
11990 you can use the @value{GDBN}
11991 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
11992 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
11993 command.
11994 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
11995 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
11996 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
11997 of each of the file's sections.
11998 For instance, if the program
11999 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
12000 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
12001
12002 @example
12003 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
12004 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
12005 @end example
12006
12007 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
12008 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
12009 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
12010
12011 @node Sparclet Execution
12012 @subsubsection Running and debugging
12013
12014 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
12015 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
12016 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
12017 manual for the list of commands.
12018
12019 @example
12020 (gdbslet) b main
12021 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
12022 (gdbslet) run
12023 Starting program: prog
12024 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
12025 3 char *symarg = 0;
12026 (gdbslet) step
12027 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
12028 (gdbslet)
12029 @end example
12030
12031 @node Sparclite
12032 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
12033
12034 @table @code
12035
12036 @kindex target sparclite
12037 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
12038 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
12039 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
12040 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
12041 remote protocol.
12042
12043 @end table
12044
12045 @node ST2000
12046 @subsection Tandem ST2000
12047
12048 @value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
12049 STDBUG protocol.
12050
12051 To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
12052 manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
12053
12054 @example
12055 target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
12056 @end example
12057
12058 @noindent
12059 to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
12060 the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
12061 ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
12062 connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
12063 concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
12064
12065 The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
12066 this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
12067 would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
12068 (such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
12069 available on your host computer.
12070 @c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
12071 @c basically hearsay.
12072
12073 @cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
12074 These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
12075 environment:
12076
12077 @table @code
12078 @item st2000 @var{command}
12079 @kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
12080 @cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
12081 @cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
12082 Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
12083 manual for available commands.
12084
12085 @item connect
12086 @cindex connect (to STDBUG)
12087 Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
12088 you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
12089 sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
12090 @kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
12091 @kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
12092 @end table
12093
12094 @node Z8000
12095 @subsection Zilog Z8000
12096
12097 @cindex Z8000
12098 @cindex simulator, Z8000
12099 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
12100
12101 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
12102 a Z8000 simulator.
12103
12104 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
12105 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
12106 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
12107 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
12108
12109 @table @code
12110 @item target sim @var{args}
12111 @kindex sim
12112 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
12113 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
12114 options, specify them via @var{args}.
12115 @end table
12116
12117 @noindent
12118 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
12119 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
12120 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
12121 to run your program, and so on.
12122
12123 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
12124 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
12125 additional items of information as specially named registers:
12126
12127 @table @code
12128
12129 @item cycles
12130 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
12131
12132 @item insts
12133 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
12134
12135 @item time
12136 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
12137
12138 @end table
12139
12140 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
12141 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
12142 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
12143 simulated clock ticks.
12144
12145 @node Architectures
12146 @section Architectures
12147
12148 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
12149 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
12150
12151 @menu
12152 * A29K::
12153 * Alpha::
12154 * MIPS::
12155 @end menu
12156
12157 @node A29K
12158 @subsection A29K
12159
12160 @table @code
12161
12162 @kindex set rstack_high_address
12163 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
12164 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
12165 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
12166 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
12167 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
12168 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
12169 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
12170 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
12171 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
12172 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
12173 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
12174 hexadecimal.
12175
12176 @kindex show rstack_high_address
12177 @item show rstack_high_address
12178 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
12179 processors.
12180
12181 @end table
12182
12183 @node Alpha
12184 @subsection Alpha
12185
12186 See the following section.
12187
12188 @node MIPS
12189 @subsection MIPS
12190
12191 @cindex stack on Alpha
12192 @cindex stack on MIPS
12193 @cindex Alpha stack
12194 @cindex MIPS stack
12195 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
12196 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
12197 find the beginning of a function.
12198
12199 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
12200 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
12201 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
12202 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
12203 commands:
12204
12205 @table @code
12206 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
12207 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
12208 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
12209 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
12210 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
12211 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
12212 and therefore the longer it takes to run.
12213
12214 @item show heuristic-fence-post
12215 Display the current limit.
12216 @end table
12217
12218 @noindent
12219 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
12220 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
12221
12222
12223 @node Controlling GDB
12224 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
12225
12226 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
12227 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
12228 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
12229 described here.
12230
12231 @menu
12232 * Prompt:: Prompt
12233 * Editing:: Command editing
12234 * History:: Command history
12235 * Screen Size:: Screen size
12236 * Numbers:: Numbers
12237 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
12238 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
12239 @end menu
12240
12241 @node Prompt
12242 @section Prompt
12243
12244 @cindex prompt
12245
12246 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
12247 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
12248 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
12249 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
12250 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
12251 which one you are talking to.
12252
12253 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
12254 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
12255 or a prompt that does not.
12256
12257 @table @code
12258 @kindex set prompt
12259 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
12260 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
12261
12262 @kindex show prompt
12263 @item show prompt
12264 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
12265 @end table
12266
12267 @node Editing
12268 @section Command editing
12269 @cindex readline
12270 @cindex command line editing
12271
12272 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
12273 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
12274 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
12275 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
12276 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
12277 debugging sessions.
12278
12279 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
12280 command @code{set}.
12281
12282 @table @code
12283 @kindex set editing
12284 @cindex editing
12285 @item set editing
12286 @itemx set editing on
12287 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
12288
12289 @item set editing off
12290 Disable command line editing.
12291
12292 @kindex show editing
12293 @item show editing
12294 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
12295 @end table
12296
12297 @node History
12298 @section Command history
12299
12300 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
12301 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
12302 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
12303 history facility.
12304
12305 @table @code
12306 @cindex history substitution
12307 @cindex history file
12308 @kindex set history filename
12309 @kindex GDBHISTFILE
12310 @item set history filename @var{fname}
12311 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
12312 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
12313 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
12314 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
12315 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
12316 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
12317 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
12318 is not set.
12319
12320 @cindex history save
12321 @kindex set history save
12322 @item set history save
12323 @itemx set history save on
12324 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
12325 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
12326
12327 @item set history save off
12328 Stop recording command history in a file.
12329
12330 @cindex history size
12331 @kindex set history size
12332 @item set history size @var{size}
12333 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
12334 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
12335 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
12336 @end table
12337
12338 @cindex history expansion
12339 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
12340 @ifset have-readline-appendices
12341 @xref{Event Designators}.
12342 @end ifset
12343
12344 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
12345 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
12346 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
12347 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
12348 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
12349 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
12350 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
12351
12352 The commands to control history expansion are:
12353
12354 @table @code
12355 @kindex set history expansion
12356 @item set history expansion on
12357 @itemx set history expansion
12358 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
12359
12360 @item set history expansion off
12361 Disable history expansion.
12362
12363 The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
12364 editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
12365 or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
12366 @ifset have-readline-appendices
12367 @xref{Command Line Editing}.
12368 @end ifset
12369
12370 @c @group
12371 @kindex show history
12372 @item show history
12373 @itemx show history filename
12374 @itemx show history save
12375 @itemx show history size
12376 @itemx show history expansion
12377 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
12378 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
12379 @c @end group
12380 @end table
12381
12382 @table @code
12383 @kindex shows
12384 @item show commands
12385 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
12386
12387 @item show commands @var{n}
12388 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
12389
12390 @item show commands +
12391 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
12392 @end table
12393
12394 @node Screen Size
12395 @section Screen size
12396 @cindex size of screen
12397 @cindex pauses in output
12398
12399 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
12400 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
12401 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
12402 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
12403 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
12404 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
12405 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
12406 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
12407
12408 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
12409 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
12410 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
12411 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
12412 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
12413 width} commands:
12414
12415 @table @code
12416 @kindex set height
12417 @kindex set width
12418 @kindex show width
12419 @kindex show height
12420 @item set height @var{lpp}
12421 @itemx show height
12422 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
12423 @itemx show width
12424 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
12425 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
12426 commands display the current settings.
12427
12428 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
12429 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
12430 file or to an editor buffer.
12431
12432 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
12433 from wrapping its output.
12434 @end table
12435
12436 @node Numbers
12437 @section Numbers
12438 @cindex number representation
12439 @cindex entering numbers
12440
12441 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
12442 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
12443 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
12444 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
12445 default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
12446 numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
12447 change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
12448 radix} command.
12449
12450 @table @code
12451 @kindex set input-radix
12452 @item set input-radix @var{base}
12453 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
12454 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12455 specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
12456 example, any of
12457
12458 @smallexample
12459 set radix 012
12460 set radix 10.
12461 set radix 0xa
12462 @end smallexample
12463
12464 @noindent
12465 sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
12466 leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
12467
12468 @kindex set output-radix
12469 @item set output-radix @var{base}
12470 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
12471 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12472 specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
12473
12474 @kindex show input-radix
12475 @item show input-radix
12476 Display the current default base for numeric input.
12477
12478 @kindex show output-radix
12479 @item show output-radix
12480 Display the current default base for numeric display.
12481 @end table
12482
12483 @node Messages/Warnings
12484 @section Optional warnings and messages
12485
12486 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
12487 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
12488 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
12489 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
12490
12491 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
12492 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
12493 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
12494
12495 @table @code
12496 @kindex set verbose
12497 @item set verbose on
12498 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
12499
12500 @item set verbose off
12501 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
12502
12503 @kindex show verbose
12504 @item show verbose
12505 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
12506 @end table
12507
12508 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
12509 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
12510 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
12511 symbol files}).
12512
12513 @table @code
12514
12515 @kindex set complaints
12516 @item set complaints @var{limit}
12517 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
12518 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
12519 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
12520 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
12521
12522 @kindex show complaints
12523 @item show complaints
12524 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
12525
12526 @end table
12527
12528 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
12529 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
12530 you try to run a program which is already running:
12531
12532 @example
12533 (@value{GDBP}) run
12534 The program being debugged has been started already.
12535 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
12536 @end example
12537
12538 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
12539 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
12540
12541 @table @code
12542
12543 @kindex set confirm
12544 @cindex flinching
12545 @cindex confirmation
12546 @cindex stupid questions
12547 @item set confirm off
12548 Disables confirmation requests.
12549
12550 @item set confirm on
12551 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
12552
12553 @kindex show confirm
12554 @item show confirm
12555 Displays state of confirmation requests.
12556
12557 @end table
12558
12559 @node Debugging Output
12560 @section Optional messages about internal happenings
12561 @table @code
12562 @kindex set debug arch
12563 @item set debug arch
12564 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
12565 @kindex show debug arch
12566 @item show debug arch
12567 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
12568 @kindex set debug event
12569 @item set debug event
12570 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
12571 default is off.
12572 @kindex show debug event
12573 @item show debug event
12574 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
12575 info.
12576 @kindex set debug expression
12577 @item set debug expression
12578 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
12579 default is off.
12580 @kindex show debug expression
12581 @item show debug expression
12582 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
12583 debugging info.
12584 @kindex set debug overload
12585 @item set debug overload
12586 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
12587 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
12588 is off.
12589 @kindex show debug overload
12590 @item show debug overload
12591 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
12592 debugging info.
12593 @kindex set debug remote
12594 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
12595 @cindex serial connections, debugging
12596 @item set debug remote
12597 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
12598 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
12599 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
12600 @kindex show debug remote
12601 @item show debug remote
12602 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
12603 @kindex set debug serial
12604 @item set debug serial
12605 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
12606 default is off.
12607 @kindex show debug serial
12608 @item show debug serial
12609 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
12610 info.
12611 @kindex set debug target
12612 @item set debug target
12613 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
12614 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
12615 default is off.
12616 @kindex show debug target
12617 @item show debug target
12618 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
12619 info.
12620 @kindex set debug varobj
12621 @item set debug varobj
12622 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
12623 info. The default is off.
12624 @kindex show debug varobj
12625 @item show debug varobj
12626 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
12627 debugging info.
12628 @end table
12629
12630 @node Sequences
12631 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
12632
12633 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
12634 command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
12635 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
12636 files.
12637
12638 @menu
12639 * Define:: User-defined commands
12640 * Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
12641 * Command Files:: Command files
12642 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
12643 @end menu
12644
12645 @node Define
12646 @section User-defined commands
12647
12648 @cindex user-defined command
12649 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
12650 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
12651 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
12652 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
12653 via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
12654
12655 @smallexample
12656 define adder
12657 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
12658 @end smallexample
12659
12660 @noindent
12661 To execute the command use:
12662
12663 @smallexample
12664 adder 1 2 3
12665 @end smallexample
12666
12667 @noindent
12668 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
12669 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
12670 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
12671 functions calls.
12672
12673 @table @code
12674
12675 @kindex define
12676 @item define @var{commandname}
12677 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
12678 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
12679
12680 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
12681 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
12682 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
12683
12684 @kindex if
12685 @kindex else
12686 @item if
12687 Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
12688 It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
12689 only if the expression is true (nonzero).
12690 There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
12691 by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
12692 was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
12693
12694 @kindex while
12695 @item while
12696 The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
12697 which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
12698 execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
12699 The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
12700 evaluates to true.
12701
12702 @kindex document
12703 @item document @var{commandname}
12704 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
12705 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
12706 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
12707 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
12708 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
12709 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
12710
12711 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
12712 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
12713 does not change the documentation.
12714
12715 @kindex help user-defined
12716 @item help user-defined
12717 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
12718 (if any) for each.
12719
12720 @kindex show user
12721 @item show user
12722 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
12723 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
12724 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
12725 definitions for all user-defined commands.
12726
12727 @end table
12728
12729 When user-defined commands are executed, the
12730 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
12731 stops execution of the user-defined command.
12732
12733 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
12734 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
12735 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
12736 messages when used in a user-defined command.
12737
12738 @node Hooks
12739 @section User-defined command hooks
12740 @cindex command hooks
12741 @cindex hooks, for commands
12742 @cindex hooks, pre-command
12743
12744 @kindex hook
12745 @kindex hook-
12746 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
12747 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
12748 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
12749 before that command.
12750
12751 @cindex hooks, post-command
12752 @kindex hookpost
12753 @kindex hookpost-
12754 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
12755 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
12756 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
12757 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
12758 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
12759
12760 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
12761 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
12762
12763 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
12764 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
12765
12766 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
12767 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
12768 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
12769 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
12770 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
12771
12772 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
12773 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
12774 you could define:
12775
12776 @example
12777 define hook-stop
12778 handle SIGALRM nopass
12779 end
12780
12781 define hook-run
12782 handle SIGALRM pass
12783 end
12784
12785 define hook-continue
12786 handle SIGLARM pass
12787 end
12788 @end example
12789
12790 As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
12791 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
12792 you could define:
12793
12794 @example
12795 define hook-echo
12796 echo <<<---
12797 end
12798
12799 define hookpost-echo
12800 echo --->>>\n
12801 end
12802
12803 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
12804 <<<---Hello World--->>>
12805 (@value{GDBP})
12806
12807 @end example
12808
12809 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
12810 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
12811 name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
12812 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
12813 @c or not?
12814 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
12815 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
12816 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
12817
12818 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
12819 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
12820
12821 @node Command Files
12822 @section Command files
12823
12824 @cindex command files
12825 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
12826 commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
12827 An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
12828 the last command, as it would from the terminal.
12829
12830 @cindex init file
12831 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
12832 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
12833 When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
12834 @dfn{init files}. These are files named @file{.gdbinit} on Unix and
12835 @file{gdb.ini} on DOS/Windows. During startup, @value{GDBN} does the
12836 following:
12837
12838 @enumerate
12839 @item
12840 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
12841 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
12842 @code{HOME} environment variable.}.
12843
12844 @item
12845 Processes command line options and operands.
12846
12847 @item
12848 Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
12849
12850 @item
12851 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
12852 @end enumerate
12853
12854 The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
12855 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
12856 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
12857 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
12858
12859 @cindex init file name
12860 On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
12861 different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
12862 form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
12863 different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
12864 environments with special init file names:
12865
12866 @cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
12867 @itemize @bullet
12868 @item
12869 VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
12870
12871 @cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
12872 @item
12873 OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
12874
12875 @cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
12876 @item
12877 ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
12878 @end itemize
12879
12880 You can also request the execution of a command file with the
12881 @code{source} command:
12882
12883 @table @code
12884 @kindex source
12885 @item source @var{filename}
12886 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
12887 @end table
12888
12889 The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
12890 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates execution
12891 of the command file.
12892
12893 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
12894 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
12895 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
12896 when called from command files.
12897
12898 @node Output
12899 @section Commands for controlled output
12900
12901 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
12902 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
12903 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
12904 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
12905 want.
12906
12907 @table @code
12908 @kindex echo
12909 @item echo @var{text}
12910 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
12911 @c because it is not in ANSI.
12912 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
12913 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
12914 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
12915 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
12916 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
12917 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
12918 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
12919 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
12920 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
12921
12922 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
12923 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
12924
12925 @example
12926 echo This is some text\n\
12927 which is continued\n\
12928 onto several lines.\n
12929 @end example
12930
12931 produces the same output as
12932
12933 @example
12934 echo This is some text\n
12935 echo which is continued\n
12936 echo onto several lines.\n
12937 @end example
12938
12939 @kindex output
12940 @item output @var{expression}
12941 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
12942 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
12943 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
12944 on expressions.
12945
12946 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
12947 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
12948 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
12949 formats}, for more information.
12950
12951 @kindex printf
12952 @item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
12953 Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
12954 @var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
12955 either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
12956 @var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
12957 subroutine
12958 @c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
12959 @c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
12960 @c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
12961 @c supported.
12962
12963 @example
12964 printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
12965 @end example
12966
12967 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
12968
12969 @smallexample
12970 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
12971 @end smallexample
12972
12973 The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
12974 string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
12975 letter.
12976 @end table
12977
12978 @node Emacs
12979 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
12980
12981 @cindex Emacs
12982 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
12983 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
12984 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
12985 @value{GDBN}.
12986
12987 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
12988 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
12989 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
12990 created Emacs buffer.
12991 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
12992
12993 Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
12994 things:
12995
12996 @itemize @bullet
12997 @item
12998 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
12999 @end itemize
13000
13001 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
13002 and output done by the program you are debugging.
13003
13004 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
13005 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
13006 in this way.
13007
13008 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
13009 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
13010 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
13011 stop.
13012
13013 @itemize @bullet
13014 @item
13015 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
13016 @end itemize
13017
13018 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
13019 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
13020 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
13021 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
13022 and the source.
13023
13024 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
13025 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
13026
13027 @quotation
13028 @emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
13029 current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
13030 the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
13031 appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
13032 environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
13033 session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
13034 back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
13035 avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
13036 your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
13037 @kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
13038
13039 A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
13040 switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
13041 @value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
13042 @end quotation
13043
13044 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
13045 you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
13046 several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
13047 Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
13048
13049 @example
13050 (setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
13051 @end example
13052
13053 @noindent
13054 (preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
13055 in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
13056 ``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
13057
13058 In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
13059 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
13060
13061 @table @kbd
13062 @item C-h m
13063 Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
13064
13065 @item M-s
13066 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
13067 update the display window to show the current file and location.
13068
13069 @item M-n
13070 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
13071 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
13072 to show the current file and location.
13073
13074 @item M-i
13075 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
13076 display window accordingly.
13077
13078 @item M-x gdb-nexti
13079 Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
13080 display window accordingly.
13081
13082 @item C-c C-f
13083 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
13084 @code{finish} command.
13085
13086 @item M-c
13087 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
13088 command.
13089
13090 @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
13091
13092 @item M-u
13093 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
13094 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
13095 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
13096
13097 @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
13098
13099 @item M-d
13100 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
13101 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
13102
13103 @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
13104
13105 @item C-x &
13106 Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
13107 of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
13108 around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
13109 then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
13110 argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
13111
13112 You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
13113 @code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
13114 otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
13115 inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
13116 wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
13117 list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
13118 formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
13119 is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
13120 @end table
13121
13122 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
13123 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
13124
13125 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
13126 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
13127 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
13128 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
13129 frame.
13130
13131 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
13132 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
13133 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
13134 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
13135 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
13136 to correspond properly with the code.
13137
13138 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
13139 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
13140 @ignore
13141 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
13142 @kindex Epoch
13143 @kindex inspect
13144
13145 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
13146 called the @code{epoch}
13147 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
13148 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
13149 each value is printed in its own window.
13150 @end ignore
13151
13152 @include annotate.texi
13153 @include gdbmi.texinfo
13154
13155 @node GDB Bugs
13156 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
13157 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
13158 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
13159
13160 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
13161
13162 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
13163 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
13164 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
13165 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
13166
13167 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
13168 information that enables us to fix the bug.
13169
13170 @menu
13171 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
13172 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
13173 @end menu
13174
13175 @node Bug Criteria
13176 @section Have you found a bug?
13177 @cindex bug criteria
13178
13179 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
13180
13181 @itemize @bullet
13182 @cindex fatal signal
13183 @cindex debugger crash
13184 @cindex crash of debugger
13185 @item
13186 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
13187 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
13188
13189 @cindex error on valid input
13190 @item
13191 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
13192 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
13193 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
13194
13195 @cindex invalid input
13196 @item
13197 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
13198 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
13199 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
13200 for traditional practice''.
13201
13202 @item
13203 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
13204 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
13205 @end itemize
13206
13207 @node Bug Reporting
13208 @section How to report bugs
13209 @cindex bug reports
13210 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
13211
13212 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
13213 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
13214 contact that organization first.
13215
13216 You can find contact information for many support companies and
13217 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
13218 distribution.
13219 @c should add a web page ref...
13220
13221 In any event, we also recommend that you send bug reports for
13222 @value{GDBN} to this addresses:
13223
13224 @example
13225 bug-gdb@@gnu.org
13226 @end example
13227
13228 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
13229 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
13230 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
13231 @samp{bug-gdb}.
13232
13233 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
13234 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
13235 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
13236 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
13237 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
13238 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
13239 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
13240 bug reports to the mailing list.
13241
13242 As a last resort, send bug reports on paper to:
13243
13244 @example
13245 @sc{gnu} Debugger Bugs
13246 Free Software Foundation Inc.
13247 59 Temple Place - Suite 330
13248 Boston, MA 02111-1307
13249 USA
13250 @end example
13251
13252 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
13253 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
13254 fact or leave it out, state it!
13255
13256 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
13257 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
13258 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
13259 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
13260 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
13261 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
13262 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
13263 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
13264 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
13265
13266 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
13267 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
13268 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
13269 self-contained.
13270
13271 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
13272 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
13273 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
13274 bugs properly.
13275
13276 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
13277
13278 @itemize @bullet
13279 @item
13280 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
13281 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
13282 version}.
13283
13284 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
13285 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
13286
13287 @item
13288 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
13289 version number.
13290
13291 @item
13292 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
13293 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
13294
13295 @item
13296 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
13297 debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
13298 C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
13299 information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
13300 compilers.
13301
13302 @item
13303 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
13304 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
13305 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
13306 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
13307
13308 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
13309 and then we might not encounter the bug.
13310
13311 @item
13312 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
13313 reproduce the bug.
13314
13315 @item
13316 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
13317 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
13318
13319 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
13320 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
13321 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
13322 a chance to make a mistake.
13323
13324 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
13325 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
13326 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
13327 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
13328 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
13329 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
13330 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
13331 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
13332
13333 @item
13334 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
13335 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
13336 it by context, not by line number.
13337
13338 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
13339 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
13340
13341 @end itemize
13342
13343 Here are some things that are not necessary:
13344
13345 @itemize @bullet
13346 @item
13347 A description of the envelope of the bug.
13348
13349 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
13350 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
13351 changes will not affect it.
13352
13353 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
13354 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
13355 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
13356 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
13357
13358 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
13359 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
13360 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
13361 less time, and so on.
13362
13363 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
13364 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
13365
13366 @item
13367 A patch for the bug.
13368
13369 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
13370 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
13371 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
13372 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
13373
13374 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
13375 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
13376 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
13377 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
13378
13379 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
13380 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
13381 help us to understand.
13382
13383 @item
13384 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
13385
13386 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
13387 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
13388 @end itemize
13389
13390 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
13391 @c and consists of the two following files:
13392 @c rluser.texinfo
13393 @c inc-hist.texinfo
13394 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
13395 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
13396 @include rluser.texinfo
13397 @include inc-hist.texinfo
13398
13399
13400 @node Formatting Documentation
13401 @appendix Formatting Documentation
13402
13403 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
13404 @cindex reference card
13405 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
13406 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
13407 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
13408 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
13409 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
13410 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
13411
13412 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
13413 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
13414
13415 @example
13416 make refcard.dvi
13417 @end example
13418
13419 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
13420 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
13421 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
13422 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
13423 your @sc{dvi} output program.
13424
13425 @cindex documentation
13426
13427 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
13428 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
13429 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
13430 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
13431 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
13432 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
13433
13434 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
13435 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
13436 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
13437 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
13438 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
13439 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
13440 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
13441 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
13442
13443 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
13444 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
13445 @code{makeinfo}.
13446
13447 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
13448 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
13449 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
13450
13451 @example
13452 cd gdb
13453 make gdb.info
13454 @end example
13455
13456 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
13457 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
13458 Texinfo definitions file.
13459
13460 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
13461 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
13462 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
13463 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
13464 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
13465 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
13466 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
13467
13468 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
13469 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
13470 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
13471 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
13472 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
13473 directory.
13474
13475 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
13476 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
13477 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
13478 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
13479
13480 @example
13481 make gdb.dvi
13482 @end example
13483
13484 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
13485
13486 @node Installing GDB
13487 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
13488 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
13489 @cindex installation
13490
13491 @value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
13492 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
13493 build the @code{gdb} program.
13494 @iftex
13495 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
13496 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
13497 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
13498 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
13499 @end iftex
13500
13501 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
13502 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
13503 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
13504
13505 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
13506 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
13507
13508 @table @code
13509 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
13510 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
13511
13512 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
13513 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
13514
13515 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
13516 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
13517
13518 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
13519 @sc{gnu} include files
13520
13521 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
13522 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
13523
13524 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
13525 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
13526
13527 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
13528 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
13529
13530 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
13531 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
13532
13533 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
13534 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
13535 @end table
13536
13537 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
13538 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
13539 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
13540
13541 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
13542 if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
13543 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
13544 argument.
13545
13546 For example:
13547
13548 @example
13549 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
13550 ./configure @var{host}
13551 make
13552 @end example
13553
13554 @noindent
13555 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
13556 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
13557 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
13558 correct value by examining your system.)
13559
13560 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
13561 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
13562 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
13563 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
13564
13565 @need 750
13566 @code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
13567 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
13568 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
13569
13570 @example
13571 sh configure @var{host}
13572 @end example
13573
13574 If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
13575 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
13576 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
13577 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
13578 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
13579
13580 You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
13581 subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
13582 configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
13583
13584 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
13585 the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
13586
13587 @example
13588 @group
13589 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
13590 ../configure @var{host}
13591 @end group
13592 @end example
13593
13594 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
13595 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
13596 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
13597 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
13598 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
13599
13600 @menu
13601 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
13602 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
13603 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
13604 @end menu
13605
13606 @node Separate Objdir
13607 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
13608
13609 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
13610 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
13611 host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
13612 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
13613 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
13614 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
13615 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
13616 program specified there.
13617
13618 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
13619 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
13620 (You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
13621 itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
13622 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
13623 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
13624
13625 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
13626 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
13627
13628 @example
13629 @group
13630 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
13631 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
13632 cd ../gdb-sun4
13633 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
13634 make
13635 @end group
13636 @end example
13637
13638 When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
13639 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
13640 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
13641 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
13642 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
13643 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
13644
13645 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
13646 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
13647 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
13648 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
13649 You specify a cross-debugging target by
13650 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
13651
13652 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
13653 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
13654 called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
13655
13656 The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
13657 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
13658 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
13659 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
13660 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
13661
13662 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
13663 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
13664 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
13665 with each other.
13666
13667 @node Config Names
13668 @section Specifying names for hosts and targets
13669
13670 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
13671 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
13672 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
13673 of information in the following pattern:
13674
13675 @example
13676 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
13677 @end example
13678
13679 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
13680 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
13681 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
13682
13683 The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
13684 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
13685 aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
13686 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
13687 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
13688 abbreviations---for example:
13689
13690 @smallexample
13691 % sh config.sub i386-linux
13692 i386-pc-linux-gnu
13693 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
13694 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
13695 % sh config.sub hp9k700
13696 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
13697 % sh config.sub sun4
13698 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
13699 % sh config.sub sun3
13700 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
13701 % sh config.sub i986v
13702 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
13703 @end smallexample
13704
13705 @noindent
13706 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
13707 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
13708
13709 @node Configure Options
13710 @section @code{configure} options
13711
13712 Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
13713 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
13714 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
13715 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
13716
13717 @example
13718 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
13719 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
13720 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
13721 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
13722 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
13723 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
13724 @var{host}
13725 @end example
13726
13727 @noindent
13728 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
13729 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
13730 @samp{--}.
13731
13732 @table @code
13733 @item --help
13734 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
13735
13736 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
13737 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
13738 @file{@var{dir}}.
13739
13740 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
13741 Configure the source to install programs under directory
13742 @file{@var{dir}}.
13743
13744 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
13745 @need 2000
13746 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
13747 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
13748 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
13749 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
13750 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
13751 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
13752 directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
13753 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
13754 directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
13755 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
13756 @var{dirname}.
13757
13758 @item --norecursion
13759 Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
13760 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
13761
13762 @item --target=@var{target}
13763 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
13764 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
13765 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
13766
13767 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
13768
13769 @item @var{host} @dots{}
13770 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
13771
13772 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
13773 @end table
13774
13775 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
13776 needed for special purposes only.
13777
13778 @node Index
13779 @unnumbered Index
13780
13781 @printindex cp
13782
13783 @tex
13784 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
13785 % meantime:
13786 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
13787 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
13788 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
13789 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
13790 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
13791 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
13792 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
13793 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
13794 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
13795 \page\colophon
13796 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
13797 @end tex
13798
13799 @c TeX can handle the contents at the start but makeinfo 3.12 can not
13800 @ifinfo
13801 @contents
13802 @end ifinfo
13803 @ifhtml
13804 @contents
13805 @end ifhtml
13806
13807 @bye
This page took 0.323541 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.